blob: b1fe76a8f61a285055c0b0c43a81de87ebc310bd [file] [log] [blame]
Nick Lewycky5d9484d2013-01-24 01:12:16 +00001//===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading -------------------------------===//
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000014#include "clang/Sema/Overload.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000015#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregora8f32e02009-10-06 17:59:45 +000016#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
John McCall7cd088e2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000017#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000018#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000019#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000020#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +000021#include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000022#include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +000023#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000024#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
25#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
26#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
27#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
28#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
29#include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
Douglas Gregor661b4932010-09-12 04:28:07 +000030#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000031#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Douglas Gregorbf3af052008-11-13 20:12:29 +000032#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +000033#include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000034#include <algorithm>
35
36namespace clang {
John McCall2a7fb272010-08-25 05:32:35 +000037using namespace sema;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000038
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000039/// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a function.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000040static ExprResult
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000041CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
42 bool HadMultipleCandidates,
Douglas Gregor5b8968c2011-07-15 16:25:15 +000043 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(),
44 const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){
Richard Smith82f145d2013-05-04 06:44:46 +000045 if (S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FoundDecl, Loc))
Faisal Valid570a922013-06-15 11:54:37 +000046 return ExprError();
47 // If FoundDecl is different from Fn (such as if one is a template
48 // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is
49 // called on both.
50 // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying
51 // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl
52 // being used.
53 if (FoundDecl != Fn && S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Fn, Loc))
Richard Smith82f145d2013-05-04 06:44:46 +000054 return ExprError();
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +000055 DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, false, Fn->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000056 VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo);
57 if (HadMultipleCandidates)
58 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000059
60 S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000061
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000062 ExprResult E = S.Owned(DRE);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000063 E = S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E.take());
64 if (E.isInvalid())
65 return ExprError();
Benjamin Kramer3fe198b2012-08-23 21:35:17 +000066 return E;
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000067}
68
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000069static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
70 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +000071 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +000072 bool CStyle,
73 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Sam Panzerd0125862012-08-16 02:38:47 +000074
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +000075static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
76 QualType &ToType,
77 bool InOverloadResolution,
78 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
79 bool CStyle);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000080static OverloadingResult
81IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
82 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
83 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
84 bool AllowExplicit);
85
86
87static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
88CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
89 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
90 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
91
92static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
93CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
94 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
95 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
96
97static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
98CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
99 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
100 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
101
102
103
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000104/// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion
105/// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000106ImplicitConversionCategory
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000107GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
108 static const ImplicitConversionCategory
109 Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
110 ICC_Identity,
111 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
112 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
113 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000114 ICC_Identity,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000115 ICC_Qualification_Adjustment,
116 ICC_Promotion,
117 ICC_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000118 ICC_Promotion,
119 ICC_Conversion,
120 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000121 ICC_Conversion,
122 ICC_Conversion,
123 ICC_Conversion,
124 ICC_Conversion,
125 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000126 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000127 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000128 ICC_Conversion,
129 ICC_Conversion,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000130 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000131 ICC_Conversion
132 };
133 return Category[(int)Kind];
134}
135
136/// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
137/// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
138ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
139 static const ImplicitConversionRank
140 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
141 ICR_Exact_Match,
142 ICR_Exact_Match,
143 ICR_Exact_Match,
144 ICR_Exact_Match,
145 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000146 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000147 ICR_Promotion,
148 ICR_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000149 ICR_Promotion,
150 ICR_Conversion,
151 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000152 ICR_Conversion,
153 ICR_Conversion,
154 ICR_Conversion,
155 ICR_Conversion,
156 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000157 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000158 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000159 ICR_Conversion,
160 ICR_Conversion,
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000161 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
162 ICR_Conversion,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000163 ICR_Conversion,
164 ICR_Writeback_Conversion
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000165 };
166 return Rank[(int)Kind];
167}
168
169/// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
170/// implicit conversion.
171const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
Nuno Lopes2550d702009-12-23 17:49:57 +0000172 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000173 "No conversion",
174 "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
175 "Array-to-pointer",
176 "Function-to-pointer",
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000177 "Noreturn adjustment",
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000178 "Qualification",
179 "Integral promotion",
180 "Floating point promotion",
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000181 "Complex promotion",
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000182 "Integral conversion",
183 "Floating conversion",
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000184 "Complex conversion",
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000185 "Floating-integral conversion",
186 "Pointer conversion",
187 "Pointer-to-member conversion",
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000188 "Boolean conversion",
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000189 "Compatible-types conversion",
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000190 "Derived-to-base conversion",
191 "Vector conversion",
192 "Vector splat",
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000193 "Complex-real conversion",
194 "Block Pointer conversion",
195 "Transparent Union Conversion"
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000196 "Writeback conversion"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000197 };
198 return Name[Kind];
199}
200
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000201/// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
202/// sequence to the identity conversion.
203void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
204 First = ICK_Identity;
205 Second = ICK_Identity;
206 Third = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000207 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000208 QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000209 ReferenceBinding = false;
210 DirectBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +0000211 IsLvalueReference = true;
212 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
213 BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +0000214 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000215 ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000216 CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000217}
218
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000219/// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
220/// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
221/// implicit conversions.
222ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
223 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
224 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
225 Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
226 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
227 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
228 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
229 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
230 return Rank;
231}
232
233/// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
234/// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000235/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000236/// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000237bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000238 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
239 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
240 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
241 // a pointer.
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000242 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
John McCallddb0ce72010-06-11 10:04:22 +0000243 (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
244 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
245 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
Anders Carlssonc8df0b62010-11-05 00:12:09 +0000246 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() ||
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000247 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
248 return true;
249
250 return false;
251}
252
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000253/// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
254/// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
255/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
256/// 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000257bool
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000258StandardConversionSequence::
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000259isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000260 QualType FromType = getFromType();
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000261 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000262
263 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
264 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
265 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
266 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
267 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
268
Douglas Gregorf9af5242011-04-15 20:45:44 +0000269 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000270 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000271 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
272
273 return false;
274}
275
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000276/// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion
277/// or after one in an implicit conversion.
278static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(const Expr *Converted) {
279 while (const ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) {
280 switch (ICE->getCastKind()) {
281 case CK_NoOp:
282 case CK_IntegralCast:
283 case CK_IntegralToBoolean:
284 case CK_IntegralToFloating:
285 case CK_FloatingToIntegral:
286 case CK_FloatingToBoolean:
287 case CK_FloatingCast:
288 Converted = ICE->getSubExpr();
289 continue;
290
291 default:
292 return Converted;
293 }
294 }
295
296 return Converted;
297}
298
299/// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing
300/// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7.
301///
302/// \param Ctx The AST context.
303/// \param Converted The result of applying this standard conversion sequence.
304/// \param ConstantValue If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
305/// value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000306/// \param ConstantType If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
307/// type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000308NarrowingKind
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +0000309StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind(ASTContext &Ctx,
310 const Expr *Converted,
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000311 APValue &ConstantValue,
312 QualType &ConstantType) const {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000313 assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++");
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000314
315 // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7:
316 // A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ...
317 QualType FromType = getToType(0);
318 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
319 switch (Second) {
320 // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or
321 //
322 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point
323 // type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual
324 // value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce
325 // the original value when converted back to the original type, or
326 case ICK_Floating_Integral:
327 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) {
328 return NK_Type_Narrowing;
329 } else if (FromType->isIntegralType(Ctx) && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
330 llvm::APSInt IntConstantValue;
331 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
332 if (Initializer &&
333 Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(IntConstantValue, Ctx)) {
334 // Convert the integer to the floating type.
335 llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType));
336 Result.convertFromAPInt(IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue.isSigned(),
337 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
338 // And back.
339 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = IntConstantValue;
340 bool ignored;
341 Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue,
342 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored);
343 // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
344 if (IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) {
345 ConstantValue = APValue(IntConstantValue);
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000346 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000347 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
348 }
349 } else {
350 // Variables are always narrowings.
351 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
352 }
353 }
354 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
355
356 // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except
357 // where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
358 // conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even
359 // if it cannot be represented exactly), or
360 case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
361 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() &&
362 Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) {
363 // FromType is larger than ToType.
364 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
365 if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) {
366 // Constant!
367 assert(ConstantValue.isFloat());
368 llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat();
369 // Convert the source value into the target type.
370 bool ignored;
371 llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert(
372 Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType),
373 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored);
374 // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of
375 // values that can be represented.
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000376 if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) {
377 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000378 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000379 }
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000380 } else {
381 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
382 }
383 }
384 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
385
386 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type
387 // that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where
388 // the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
389 // conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original
390 // value when converted back to the original type.
391 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: // Bools are integers too.
392 if (!FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
393 // Boolean conversions can be from pointers and pointers to members
394 // [conv.bool], and those aren't considered narrowing conversions.
395 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
396 } // Otherwise, fall through to the integral case.
397 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: {
398 assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
399 assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
400 const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
401 const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType);
402 const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
403 const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType);
404
405 if (FromWidth > ToWidth ||
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000406 (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned) ||
407 (FromSigned && !ToSigned)) {
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000408 // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType.
409 llvm::APSInt InitializerValue;
410 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000411 if (!Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(InitializerValue, Ctx)) {
412 // Such conversions on variables are always narrowing.
413 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
Richard Smith5d7700e2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000414 }
415 bool Narrowing = false;
416 if (FromWidth < ToWidth) {
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000417 // Negative -> unsigned is narrowing. Otherwise, more bits is never
418 // narrowing.
419 if (InitializerValue.isSigned() && InitializerValue.isNegative())
Richard Smith5d7700e2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000420 Narrowing = true;
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000421 } else {
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000422 // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about
423 // signed vs. unsigned comparisons.
424 InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend(
425 InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1);
426 // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness.
427 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue;
428 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth);
429 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned);
430 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth());
431 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned());
432 // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
Richard Smith5d7700e2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000433 if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue)
434 Narrowing = true;
435 }
436 if (Narrowing) {
437 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
438 ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue);
439 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000440 }
441 }
442 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
443 }
444
445 default:
446 // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings.
447 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
448 }
449}
450
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000451/// DebugPrint - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
452/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
453void StandardConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000454 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000455 bool PrintedSomething = false;
456 if (First != ICK_Identity) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000457 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000458 PrintedSomething = true;
459 }
460
461 if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
462 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000463 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000464 }
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000465 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000466
467 if (CopyConstructor) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000468 OS << " (by copy constructor)";
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000469 } else if (DirectBinding) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000470 OS << " (direct reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000471 } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000472 OS << " (reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000473 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000474 PrintedSomething = true;
475 }
476
477 if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
478 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000479 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000480 }
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000481 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000482 PrintedSomething = true;
483 }
484
485 if (!PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000486 OS << "No conversions required";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000487 }
488}
489
490/// DebugPrint - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
491/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
492void UserDefinedConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000493 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000494 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
495 Before.DebugPrint();
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000496 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000497 }
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +0000498 if (ConversionFunction)
499 OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\'';
500 else
501 OS << "aggregate initialization";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000502 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000503 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000504 After.DebugPrint();
505 }
506}
507
508/// DebugPrint - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
509/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
510void ImplicitConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000511 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000512 switch (ConversionKind) {
513 case StandardConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000514 OS << "Standard conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000515 Standard.DebugPrint();
516 break;
517 case UserDefinedConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000518 OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000519 UserDefined.DebugPrint();
520 break;
521 case EllipsisConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000522 OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000523 break;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000524 case AmbiguousConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000525 OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000526 break;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000527 case BadConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000528 OS << "Bad conversion";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000529 break;
530 }
531
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000532 OS << "\n";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000533}
534
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000535void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
536 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
537}
538
539void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
540 conversions().~ConversionSet();
541}
542
543void
544AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
545 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
546 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
547 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
548}
549
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000550namespace {
551 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000552 // template argument information.
553 struct DFIArguments {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000554 TemplateArgument FirstArg;
555 TemplateArgument SecondArg;
556 };
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000557 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store
558 // template parameter and template argument information.
559 struct DFIParamWithArguments : DFIArguments {
560 TemplateParameter Param;
561 };
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000562}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000563
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000564/// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
565/// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
566OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000567static MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
568 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
John McCall2a7fb272010-08-25 05:32:35 +0000569 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000570 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo Result;
571 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000572 Result.HasDiagnostic = false;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000573 Result.Data = 0;
574 switch (TDK) {
575 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000576 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000577 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000578 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
579 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000580 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000581
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000582 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000583 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000584 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
585 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000586
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000587 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
588 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
589 DFIArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIArguments;
590 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
591 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
592 Result.Data = Saved;
593 break;
594 }
595
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000596 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000597 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000598 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
599 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000600 Saved->Param = Info.Param;
601 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
602 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
603 Result.Data = Saved;
604 break;
605 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000606
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000607 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000608 Result.Data = Info.take();
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000609 if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
610 PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt(
611 SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic());
612 Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag);
613 Result.HasDiagnostic = true;
614 }
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000615 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000616
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000617 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Richard Smith0efa62f2013-01-31 04:03:12 +0000618 Result.Data = Info.Expression;
619 break;
620
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000621 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000622 break;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000623 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000624
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000625 return Result;
626}
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000627
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000628void OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
629 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
630 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000631 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000632 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
633 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000634 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
635 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000636 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000637 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000638 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000639
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000640 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000641 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000642 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregoraaa045d2010-05-08 20:20:05 +0000643 // FIXME: Destroy the data?
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000644 Data = 0;
645 break;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000646
647 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000648 // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list?
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000649 Data = 0;
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000650 if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
651 Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt();
652 HasDiagnostic = false;
653 }
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000654 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000655
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000656 // Unhandled
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000657 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000658 break;
659 }
660}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000661
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000662PartialDiagnosticAt *
663OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() {
664 if (HasDiagnostic)
665 return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic));
666 return 0;
667}
668
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000669TemplateParameter
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000670OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
671 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
672 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000673 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000674 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000675 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
676 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000677 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000678 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
679 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000680 return TemplateParameter();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000681
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000682 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000683 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000684 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000685
686 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000687 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000688 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000689
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000690 // Unhandled
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000691 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000692 break;
693 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000694
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000695 return TemplateParameter();
696}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000697
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000698TemplateArgumentList *
699OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
700 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000701 case Sema::TDK_Success:
702 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
703 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
704 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
705 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
706 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
707 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
708 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
709 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
710 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
711 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
712 return 0;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000713
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000714 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
715 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000716
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000717 // Unhandled
718 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
719 break;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000720 }
721
722 return 0;
723}
724
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000725const TemplateArgument *OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
726 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
727 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000728 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000729 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
730 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000731 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
732 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000733 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000734 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000735 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000736 return 0;
737
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000738 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000739 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000740 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
741 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000742
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000743 // Unhandled
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000744 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000745 break;
746 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000747
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000748 return 0;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000749}
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000750
751const TemplateArgument *
752OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
753 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
754 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000755 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000756 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
757 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000758 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
759 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000760 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000761 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000762 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000763 return 0;
764
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000765 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000766 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000767 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
768 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000769
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000770 // Unhandled
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000771 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000772 break;
773 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000774
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000775 return 0;
776}
777
Richard Smith0efa62f2013-01-31 04:03:12 +0000778Expr *
779OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getExpr() {
780 if (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result) ==
781 Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution)
782 return static_cast<Expr*>(Data);
783
784 return 0;
785}
786
Benjamin Kramerf5b132f2012-10-09 15:52:25 +0000787void OverloadCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
Richard Smithe3898ac2012-07-18 23:52:59 +0000788 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
Benjamin Kramer9e2822b2012-01-14 20:16:52 +0000789 for (unsigned ii = 0, ie = i->NumConversions; ii != ie; ++ii)
790 i->Conversions[ii].~ImplicitConversionSequence();
Richard Smithe3898ac2012-07-18 23:52:59 +0000791 if (!i->Viable && i->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
792 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
793 }
Benjamin Kramerf5b132f2012-10-09 15:52:25 +0000794}
795
796void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() {
797 destroyCandidates();
Benjamin Kramer314f5542012-01-14 19:31:39 +0000798 NumInlineSequences = 0;
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +0000799 Candidates.clear();
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000800 Functions.clear();
801}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000802
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000803namespace {
804 class UnbridgedCastsSet {
805 struct Entry {
806 Expr **Addr;
807 Expr *Saved;
808 };
809 SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries;
810
811 public:
812 void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) {
813 assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast));
814 Entry entry = { &E, E };
815 Entries.push_back(entry);
816 E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
817 }
818
819 void restore() {
820 for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator
821 i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i)
822 *i->Addr = i->Saved;
823 }
824 };
825}
826
827/// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like
828/// preprocessing on the given expression.
829///
830/// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts;
831/// without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors
832///
833/// Return true on unrecoverable error.
834static bool checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E,
835 UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = 0) {
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000836 if (const BuiltinType *placeholder = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
837 // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload
838 // resolution might reasonably tweak them.
839 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false;
840
841 // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip
842 // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration.
843 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
844 unbridgedCasts) {
845 unbridgedCasts->save(S, E);
846 return false;
847 }
848
849 // Go ahead and check everything else.
850 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
851 if (result.isInvalid())
852 return true;
853
854 E = result.take();
855 return false;
856 }
857
858 // Nothing to do.
859 return false;
860}
861
862/// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for
863/// placeholders.
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +0000864static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S,
865 MultiExprArg Args,
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000866 UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) {
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +0000867 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i)
868 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, Args[i], &unbridged))
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000869 return true;
870
871 return false;
872}
873
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000874// IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000875// overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if
876// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same
877// signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old
878// declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000879// it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New
880// cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on
881// top of the underlying declaration.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000882//
883// Example: Given the following input:
884//
885// void f(int, float); // #1
886// void f(int, int); // #2
887// int f(int, int); // #3
888//
889// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f",
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000890// so IsOverload will not be used.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000891//
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000892// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By
893// comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded
894// (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns
895// false; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000896//
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000897// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
898// compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do
899// nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are
900// identical (return types of functions are not part of the
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000901// signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to
902// point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000903//
904// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced
905// into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide
906// shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure
907// into a function template's signature.
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000908Sema::OverloadKind
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000909Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
910 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000911 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000912 I != E; ++I) {
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000913 NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
914
915 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
916 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
917 OldIsUsingDecl = true;
918
919 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
920 // context, even if they have identical signatures.
921 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
922
923 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
924 }
925
926 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
927 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
928 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
929 // function templates hide function templates with different
930 // return types or template parameter lists.
931 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
John McCall78037ac2013-04-03 21:19:47 +0000932 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord() &&
933 !New->getFriendObjectKind();
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000934
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000935 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldT = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000936 if (!IsOverload(New, OldT->getTemplatedDecl(), UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
937 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
938 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
939 continue;
940 }
941
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000942 Match = *I;
943 return Ovl_Match;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000944 }
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000945 } else if (FunctionDecl *OldF = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000946 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
947 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
948 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
949 continue;
950 }
951
Rafael Espindola90cc3902013-04-15 12:49:13 +0000952 if (!shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(*I, New))
953 continue;
954
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000955 Match = *I;
956 return Ovl_Match;
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000957 }
John McCalld7945c62010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000958 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCall9f54ad42009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000959 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
960 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
961 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
John McCalld7945c62010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000962 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
963 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
John McCall9f54ad42009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000964 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
965 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
966 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
967 // template instantiation.
968 } else {
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000969 // (C++ 13p1):
970 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
971 // declarations cannot be overloaded.
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000972 Match = *I;
973 return Ovl_NonFunction;
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000974 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000975 }
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000976
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000977 return Ovl_Overload;
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000978}
979
Rafael Espindola78eeba82012-12-28 14:21:58 +0000980static bool canBeOverloaded(const FunctionDecl &D) {
981 if (D.getAttr<OverloadableAttr>())
982 return true;
Rafael Espindolad2fdd422013-02-14 01:47:04 +0000983 if (D.isExternC())
Rafael Espindola78eeba82012-12-28 14:21:58 +0000984 return false;
Rafael Espindola7a525ac2013-01-12 01:47:40 +0000985
986 // Main cannot be overloaded (basic.start.main).
987 if (D.isMain())
988 return false;
989
Rafael Espindola78eeba82012-12-28 14:21:58 +0000990 return true;
991}
992
Rafael Espindola2d1b0962013-03-14 03:07:35 +0000993static bool shouldTryToOverload(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
994 bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000995 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
996 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
997
998 // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
999 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
1000 // and with normal (non-template) functions.
1001 if ((OldTemplate == 0) != (NewTemplate == 0))
1002 return true;
1003
1004 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
Rafael Espindola2d1b0962013-03-14 03:07:35 +00001005 QualType OldQType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
1006 QualType NewQType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001007
1008 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
1009 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
1010 // in the signature, they are overloads.
1011
1012 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
1013 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
1014 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
1015 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
1016 return false;
1017
John McCallf4c73712011-01-19 06:33:43 +00001018 const FunctionProtoType* OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
1019 const FunctionProtoType* NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001020
1021 // The signature of a function includes the types of its
1022 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
1023 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
1024 if (OldQType != NewQType &&
1025 (OldType->getNumArgs() != NewType->getNumArgs() ||
1026 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
Rafael Espindola2d1b0962013-03-14 03:07:35 +00001027 !S.FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001028 return true;
1029
1030 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
1031 // The signature of a function template consists of its function
1032 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
1033 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
1034 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
1035 // signature.
1036 //
1037 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
1038 // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00001039 //
1040 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
1041 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
1042 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
Rafael Espindola2d1b0962013-03-14 03:07:35 +00001043 (!S.TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1044 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1045 false, S.TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001046 OldType->getResultType() != NewType->getResultType()))
1047 return true;
1048
1049 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
Douglas Gregor57c9f4f2011-01-26 17:47:49 +00001050 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001051 //
1052 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
1053 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
1054 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
1055 // this check is important to determine whether these functions
1056 // can be overloaded.
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001057 CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
1058 CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001059 if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001060 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic()) {
1061 if (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier()) {
1062 if (!UseUsingDeclRules &&
1063 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
1064 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
1065 // C++0x [over.load]p2:
1066 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
1067 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template
1068 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
1069 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
1070 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
Rafael Espindola2d1b0962013-03-14 03:07:35 +00001071 S.Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001072 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
Rafael Espindola2d1b0962013-03-14 03:07:35 +00001073 S.Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001074 }
1075 return true;
Douglas Gregorb145ee62011-01-26 21:20:37 +00001076 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001077
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001078 // We may not have applied the implicit const for a constexpr member
1079 // function yet (because we haven't yet resolved whether this is a static
1080 // or non-static member function). Add it now, on the assumption that this
1081 // is a redeclaration of OldMethod.
1082 unsigned NewQuals = NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers();
Richard Smithdb2fe732013-06-25 18:46:26 +00001083 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y && NewMethod->isConstexpr() &&
1084 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewMethod))
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001085 NewQuals |= Qualifiers::Const;
1086 if (OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers() != NewQuals)
1087 return true;
Douglas Gregorb145ee62011-01-26 21:20:37 +00001088 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001089
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001090 // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
1091 return false;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001092}
1093
Rafael Espindola2d1b0962013-03-14 03:07:35 +00001094bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
1095 bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
1096 if (!shouldTryToOverload(*this, New, Old, UseUsingDeclRules))
1097 return false;
1098
1099 // If both of the functions are extern "C", then they are not
1100 // overloads.
1101 if (!canBeOverloaded(*Old) && !canBeOverloaded(*New))
1102 return false;
1103
1104 return true;
1105}
1106
Argyrios Kyrtzidis572bbec2011-06-23 00:41:50 +00001107/// \brief Checks availability of the function depending on the current
1108/// function context. Inside an unavailable function, unavailability is ignored.
1109///
1110/// \returns true if \arg FD is unavailable and current context is inside
1111/// an available function, false otherwise.
1112bool Sema::isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(FunctionDecl *FD) {
1113 return FD->isUnavailable() && !cast<Decl>(CurContext)->isUnavailable();
1114}
1115
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001116/// \brief Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType.
1117///
1118/// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion
1119/// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information.
1120static ImplicitConversionSequence
1121TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1122 bool SuppressUserConversions,
1123 bool AllowExplicit,
1124 bool InOverloadResolution,
1125 bool CStyle,
1126 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1127 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1128
1129 if (SuppressUserConversions) {
1130 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
1131 // we can perform.
1132 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1133 return ICS;
1134 }
1135
1136 // Attempt user-defined conversion.
1137 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc());
1138 OverloadingResult UserDefResult
1139 = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions,
1140 AllowExplicit);
1141
1142 if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) {
1143 ICS.setUserDefined();
1144 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1145 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1146 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1147 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1148 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
1149 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1150 // called for those cases.
1151 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
1152 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
1153 QualType FromCanon
1154 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
1155 QualType ToCanon
1156 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
1157 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
1158 (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
1159 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
1160 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
1161 ICS.setStandard();
1162 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1163 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
1164 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1165 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
1166 if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
1167 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1168 }
1169 }
1170
1171 // C++ [over.best.ics]p4:
1172 // However, when considering the argument of a user-defined
1173 // conversion function that is a candidate by 13.3.1.3 when
1174 // invoked for the copying of the temporary in the second step
1175 // of a class copy-initialization, or by 13.3.1.4, 13.3.1.5, or
1176 // 13.3.1.6 in all cases, only standard conversion sequences and
1177 // ellipsis conversion sequences are allowed.
1178 if (SuppressUserConversions && ICS.isUserDefined()) {
1179 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::suppressed_user, From, ToType);
1180 }
1181 } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) {
1182 ICS.setAmbiguous();
1183 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
1184 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
1185 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
1186 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
1187 if (Cand->Viable)
1188 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
1189 } else {
1190 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1191 }
1192
1193 return ICS;
1194}
1195
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001196/// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
1197/// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
1198/// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
1199/// to perform the initialization. Given
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001200///
1201/// void f(float f);
1202/// void g(int i) { f(i); }
1203///
1204/// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
1205/// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
1206/// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
1207/// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
1208//
1209/// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
1210/// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
1211/// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
1212/// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
1213/// "BadConversion".
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001214///
1215/// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
1216/// not permitted.
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00001217/// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
1218/// permitted.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001219///
1220/// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C
1221/// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to
1222/// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001223static ImplicitConversionSequence
1224TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1225 bool SuppressUserConversions,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001226 bool AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001227 bool InOverloadResolution,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001228 bool CStyle,
1229 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001230 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001231 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001232 ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001233 ICS.setStandard();
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00001234 return ICS;
1235 }
1236
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001237 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00001238 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00001239 return ICS;
1240 }
1241
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00001242 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1243 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1244 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1245 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1246 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
1247 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1248 // called for those cases.
1249 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1250 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001251 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
1252 S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) {
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001253 ICS.setStandard();
1254 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1255 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
1256 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001257
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001258 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
1259 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
1260 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
1261 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
1262 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001263
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001264 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001265 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001266 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001267
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00001268 return ICS;
1269 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001270
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001271 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
1272 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1273 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001274}
1275
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001276ImplicitConversionSequence
1277Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1278 bool SuppressUserConversions,
1279 bool AllowExplicit,
1280 bool InOverloadResolution,
1281 bool CStyle,
1282 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1283 return clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1284 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit,
1285 InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1286 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001287}
1288
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001289/// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001290/// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001291/// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
1292/// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
1293/// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001294ExprResult
1295Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redl091fffe2011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001296 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001297 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Sebastian Redl091fffe2011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001298 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001299}
1300
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001301ExprResult
1302Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001303 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
Sebastian Redl091fffe2011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001304 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001305 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
1306 return ExprError();
1307
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001308 // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion.
1309 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001310 = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001311 (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending);
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001312
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001313 ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1314 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
1315 AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001316 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001317 /*CStyle=*/false,
1318 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001319 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
1320}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001321
1322/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001323/// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type.
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001324bool Sema::IsNoReturnConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1325 QualType &ResultTy) {
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001326 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1327 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001328
John McCall00ccbef2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00001329 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
1330 // where F adds one of the following at most once:
1331 // - a pointer
1332 // - a member pointer
1333 // - a block pointer
1334 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1335 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1336 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1337 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1338 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
1339 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
1340 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1341 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1342 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
1343 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1344 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1345 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
1346 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1347 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1348 } else {
1349 return false;
1350 }
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001351
John McCall00ccbef2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00001352 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1353 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1354 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
1355 return false;
1356 }
1357
1358 const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
1359 FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
1360 if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false;
1361
1362 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false));
1363 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
1364 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
1365
1366 ResultTy = ToType;
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001367 return true;
1368}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001369
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001370/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1371/// vector conversion.
1372///
1373/// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
1374/// conversion.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001375static bool IsVectorConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
1376 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001377 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
1378 // conversion.
1379 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
1380 return false;
1381
1382 // Identical types require no conversions.
1383 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1384 return false;
1385
1386 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
1387 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
1388 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
1389 // identity conversion.
1390 if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
1391 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001392
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001393 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00001394 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001395 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
1396 return true;
1397 }
1398 }
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001399
1400 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
1401 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
1402 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
1403 // same size
1404 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
1405 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001406 (Context.getLangOpts().LaxVectorConversions &&
Chandler Carruthc45eb9c2010-08-08 05:02:51 +00001407 (Context.getTypeSize(FromType) == Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001408 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1409 return true;
1410 }
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001411 }
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001412
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001413 return false;
1414}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001415
Douglas Gregor7d000652012-04-12 20:48:09 +00001416static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1417 bool InOverloadResolution,
1418 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1419 bool CStyle);
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001420
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001421/// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1422/// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1423/// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1424/// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1425/// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1426/// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1427/// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1428/// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001429static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1430 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001431 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001432 bool CStyle,
1433 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001434 QualType FromType = From->getType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001435
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001436 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00001437 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001438 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001439 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001440 SCS.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001441 SCS.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001442
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001443 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001444 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001445 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001446 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001447 return false;
1448
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001449 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001450 }
1451
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001452 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1453 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1454 // (C++ 4p1).
1455
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001456 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001457 DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1458 if (FunctionDecl *Fn
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001459 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001460 AccessPair)) {
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001461 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1462 // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1463 FromType = Fn->getType();
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001464
1465 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1466 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1467 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1468 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1469 QualType resultTy;
1470 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001471 if (!S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType,
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001472 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1473 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1474 if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1475 return false;
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001476 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001477
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001478 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1479 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1480 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1481 // expression.
1482 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1483 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1484 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1485 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1486 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1487 == UO_AddrOf &&
1488 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1489 const Type *ClassType
1490 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1491 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
Chandler Carruthfc5c8fc2011-03-29 18:38:10 +00001492 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1493 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1494 UO_AddrOf &&
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001495 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1496 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1497 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001498
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001499 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001500 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1501 FromType,
1502 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001503 } else {
1504 return false;
1505 }
Anders Carlsson2bd62502010-11-04 05:28:09 +00001506 }
John McCall21480112011-08-30 00:57:29 +00001507 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1):
1508 // A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can
1509 // be converted to a prvalue.
1510 bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue();
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001511 if (argIsLValue &&
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00001512 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001513 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001514 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001515
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001516 // C11 6.3.2.1p2:
1517 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version
1518 // of the type of the lvalue ...
1519 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>())
1520 FromType = Atomic->getValueType();
1521
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001522 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1523 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001524 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1525 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001526 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001527 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1528 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001529 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001530
1531 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1532 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1533 // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001534 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001535
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001536 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001537 // This conversion is deprecated. (C++ D.4).
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001538 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001539
1540 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1541 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1542 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1543 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001544 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1545 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001546 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001547 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001548 return true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001549 }
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001550 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001551 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001552 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001553
1554 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1555 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1556 // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001557 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001558 } else {
1559 // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001560 SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001561 }
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001562 SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001563
1564 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1565 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1566 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1567 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001568 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1569 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001570 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001571 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001572 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001573 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1574 // conversion to do.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001575 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001576 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001577 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001578 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001579 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001580 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001581 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001582 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001583 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001584 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001585 // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001586 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1587 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001588 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1589 (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1590 FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1591 FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1592 FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
1593 FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
1594 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1595 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1596 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001597 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001598 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001599 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001600 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001601 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Richard Smith42860f12013-05-10 20:29:50 +00001602 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001603 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001604 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1605 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001606 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1607 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
Chandler Carruth23a370f2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001608 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1609 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1610 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor0c293ea2010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001611 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
Chandler Carruth23a370f2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001612 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1613 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1614 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001615 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001616 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001617 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
Douglas Gregor0c293ea2010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001618 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001619 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001620 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001621 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001622 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001623 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
1624 } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion &&
1625 S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1626 SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001627 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1628 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001629 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001630 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001631 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001632 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001633 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001634 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001635 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001636 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001637 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001638 SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1639 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001640 } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001641 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001642 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001643 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001644 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001645 } else if (S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001646 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion.
1647 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment;
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001648 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1649 InOverloadResolution,
1650 SCS, CStyle)) {
1651 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1652 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregor7d000652012-04-12 20:48:09 +00001653 } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1654 CStyle)) {
1655 // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001656 // appropriately.
1657 return true;
Guy Benyei6959acd2013-02-07 16:05:33 +00001658 } else if (ToType->isEventT() &&
1659 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) &&
1660 (From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0)) {
1661 SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion;
1662 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001663 } else {
1664 // No second conversion required.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001665 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001666 }
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001667 SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001668
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001669 QualType CanonFrom;
1670 QualType CanonTo;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001671 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1).
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001672 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1673 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle,
1674 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) {
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001675 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001676 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001677 FromType = ToType;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001678 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1679 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001680 } else {
1681 // No conversion required
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001682 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1683
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001684 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001685 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1686 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1687 // a conversion. [...]
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001688 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1689 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001690 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001691 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
Matt Arsenault5509f372013-02-26 21:15:54 +00001692 CanonFrom.getLocalQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalQualifiers()) {
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001693 FromType = ToType;
1694 CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1695 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001696 }
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001697 SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001698
1699 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1700 // this is a bad conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001701 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo)
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001702 return false;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001703
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001704 return true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001705}
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001706
1707static bool
1708IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
1709 QualType &ToType,
1710 bool InOverloadResolution,
1711 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1712 bool CStyle) {
1713
1714 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
1715 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
1716 return false;
1717 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
1718 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
1719 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
1720 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
1721 itend = UD->field_end();
1722 it != itend; ++it) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001723 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1724 CStyle, /*ObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001725 ToType = it->getType();
1726 return true;
1727 }
1728 }
1729 return false;
1730}
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001731
1732/// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1733/// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1734/// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1735/// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001736bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001737 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Sebastian Redlf7be9442008-11-04 15:59:10 +00001738 // All integers are built-in.
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001739 if (!To) {
1740 return false;
1741 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001742
1743 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1744 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1745 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1746 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1747 // int (C++ 4.5p1).
Douglas Gregoraa74a1e2010-02-02 20:10:50 +00001748 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1749 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001750 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1751 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1752 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1753 // less than int to an int.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001754 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() &&
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001755 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001756 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001757 }
1758
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001759 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1760 }
1761
Richard Smithe7ff9192012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001762 // C++11 [conv.prom]p3:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001763 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
1764 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
1765 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
1766 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
1767 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001768 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001769 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001770 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001771 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
1772 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001773 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
Richard Smithe7ff9192012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001774 // C++11 [conv.prom]p4:
1775 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed
1776 // can be converted to a prvalue of its underlying type. Moreover, if
1777 // integral promotion can be applied to its underlying type, a prvalue of an
1778 // unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed can also be
1779 // converted to a prvalue of the promoted underlying type.
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001780 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1781 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
1782 // provided for a scoped enumeration.
1783 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
1784 return false;
1785
Richard Smithe7ff9192012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001786 // We can perform an integral promotion to the underlying type of the enum,
1787 // even if that's not the promoted type.
1788 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isFixed()) {
1789 QualType Underlying = FromEnumType->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
1790 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Underlying, ToType) ||
1791 IsIntegralPromotion(From, Underlying, ToType);
1792 }
1793
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001794 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001795 if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00001796 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, 0))
John McCall842aef82009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001797 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType,
1798 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001799 }
John McCall842aef82009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001800
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001801 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001802 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
1803 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
1804 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001805 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001806 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001807 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001808 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001809 // type.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001810 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001811 ToType->isIntegerType()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001812 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
1813 // unsigned.
David Majnemer0ad92312011-07-22 21:09:04 +00001814 bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001815 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001816
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001817 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
1818 // order. Try each of these types.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001819 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
1820 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
Douglas Gregorc9467cf2008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001821 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
1822 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001823 };
Douglas Gregorc9467cf2008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001824 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001825 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1826 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001827 (FromSize == ToSize &&
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001828 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
1829 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
1830 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
1831 // promotion.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001832 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001833 }
1834 }
1835 }
1836
1837 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
1838 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
1839 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
1840 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
1841 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
1842 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
1843 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00001844 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
1845 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001846 using llvm::APSInt;
1847 if (From)
John McCall993f43f2013-05-06 21:39:12 +00001848 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getSourceBitField()) {
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001849 APSInt BitWidth;
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00001850 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001851 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
1852 APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
1853 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001854
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001855 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
1856 if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
1857 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
1858 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1859 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001860
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001861 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
1862 // that fits into an unsigned int?
1863 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
1864 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1865 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001866
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001867 return false;
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001868 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001869 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001870
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001871 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
1872 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001873 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001874 return true;
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001875 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001876
1877 return false;
1878}
1879
1880/// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
1881/// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
1882/// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001883bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001884 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1885 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001886 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
1887 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001888 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
1889 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
1890 return true;
1891
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001892 // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
1893 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
1894 // double is promoted to long double [...].
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001895 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001896 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
1897 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
1898 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble))
1899 return true;
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001900
1901 // Half can be promoted to float.
Joey Gouly19dbb202013-01-23 11:56:20 +00001902 if (!getLangOpts().NativeHalfType &&
1903 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half &&
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001904 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
1905 return true;
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001906 }
1907
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001908 return false;
1909}
1910
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001911/// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
1912///
1913/// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
1914/// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
Douglas Gregorb7b5d132009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001915/// floating-point or integral promotion.
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001916bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001917 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001918 if (!FromComplex)
1919 return false;
1920
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001921 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001922 if (!ToComplex)
1923 return false;
1924
1925 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
Douglas Gregorb7b5d132009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001926 ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
1927 IsIntegralPromotion(0, FromComplex->getElementType(),
1928 ToComplex->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001929}
1930
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001931/// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1932/// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
1933/// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
1934/// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
1935/// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001936///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001937static QualType
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001938BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001939 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001940 ASTContext &Context,
1941 bool StripObjCLifetime = false) {
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001942 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
1943 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
1944 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001945
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001946 /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
1947 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Douglas Gregor143c7ac2010-12-06 22:09:19 +00001948 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001949
1950 QualType CanonFromPointee
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001951 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001952 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001953 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001954
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001955 if (StripObjCLifetime)
1956 Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
1957
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001958 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001959 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001960 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001961 if (!ToType.isNull())
Douglas Gregoraf7bea52010-05-25 15:31:05 +00001962 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001963
1964 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
1965 // already.
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001966 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1967 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001968 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
1969 }
1970
1971 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001972 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
1973 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001974
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001975 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1976 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1977 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001978}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001979
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001980static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001981 bool InOverloadResolution,
1982 ASTContext &Context) {
1983 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
1984 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
1985 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00001986 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001987 return !InOverloadResolution;
1988
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001989 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1990 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1991 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001992}
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001993
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001994/// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1995/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
1996/// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
1997/// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
1998/// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
1999/// ConvertedType.
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002000///
Douglas Gregor7ca09762008-11-27 01:19:21 +00002001/// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
2002/// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
2003/// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
2004/// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
2005/// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
2006/// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00002007/// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
2008/// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
2009/// should result in a warning.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002010bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Anders Carlsson08972922009-08-28 15:33:32 +00002011 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00002012 QualType& ConvertedType,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002013 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00002014 IncompatibleObjC = false;
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002015 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
2016 IncompatibleObjC))
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002017 return true;
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00002018
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002019 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
2020 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002021 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor27b09ac2008-12-22 20:51:52 +00002022 ConvertedType = ToType;
2023 return true;
2024 }
2025
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002026 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
2027 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002028 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002029 ConvertedType = ToType;
2030 return true;
2031 }
2032 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
2033 // pointer type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002034 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002035 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002036 ConvertedType = ToType;
2037 return true;
2038 }
2039
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00002040 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
2041 // pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002042 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002043 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00002044 ConvertedType = ToType;
2045 return true;
2046 }
2047
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002048 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002049 if (!ToTypePtr)
2050 return false;
2051
2052 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002053 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002054 ConvertedType = ToType;
2055 return true;
2056 }
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00002057
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002058 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00002059 // , including objective-c pointers.
2060 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002061 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() &&
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002062 !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002063 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
2064 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
2065 ToPointeeType,
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00002066 ToType, Context);
2067 return true;
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00002068 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002069 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002070 if (!FromTypePtr)
2071 return false;
2072
2073 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002074
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002075 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
Douglas Gregor4e938f57b2010-08-18 21:25:30 +00002076 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
2077 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
2078 return false;
2079
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002080 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
2081 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
2082 // 4.10p2).
Eli Friedman13578692010-08-05 02:49:48 +00002083 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
2084 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002085 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbf408182008-11-27 00:52:49 +00002086 ToPointeeType,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002087 ToType, Context,
2088 /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002089 return true;
2090 }
2091
Francois Picheta8ef3ac2011-05-08 22:52:41 +00002092 // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002093 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() &&
Francois Picheta8ef3ac2011-05-08 22:52:41 +00002094 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2095 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2096 ToPointeeType,
2097 ToType, Context);
2098 return true;
2099 }
2100
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002101 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
2102 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002103 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002104 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002105 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002106 ToPointeeType,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002107 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002108 return true;
2109 }
2110
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002111 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002112 //
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002113 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
2114 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
2115 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
2116 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
2117 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
2118 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
2119 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
2120 // the null pointer value of the destination type.
2121 //
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002122 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
2123 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002124 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002125 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
Douglas Gregorbf1764c2010-02-22 17:06:41 +00002126 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00002127 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002128 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002129 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbf408182008-11-27 00:52:49 +00002130 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002131 ToType, Context);
2132 return true;
2133 }
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002134
Fariborz Jahanian5da3c082011-04-14 20:33:36 +00002135 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
2136 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2137 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2138 ToPointeeType,
2139 ToType, Context);
2140 return true;
2141 }
2142
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002143 return false;
2144}
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002145
2146/// \brief Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type.
2147static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){
2148 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers();
2149
2150 // Check whether qualifiers already match.
2151 if (TQs == Qs)
2152 return T;
2153
2154 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs))
2155 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs);
2156
2157 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2158}
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002159
2160/// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
2161/// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
2162/// with the same arguments and return values.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002163bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002164 QualType& ConvertedType,
2165 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002166 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1)
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002167 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002168
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002169 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from.
2170 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers();
2171
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002172 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002173 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
2174 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002175 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002176 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002177
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002178 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002179 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
2180 // then this is not a pointer conversion.
2181 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2182 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2183 return false;
2184
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002185 // Check for compatible
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002186 // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002187 // pointer to any interface (in both directions).
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002188 if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002189 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002190 return true;
2191 }
2192 // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002193 if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002194 ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002195 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType,
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00002196 /*compare=*/false)) {
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002197 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002198 return true;
2199 }
2200 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an
2201 // interface to a pointer to a different interface.
2202 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
Fariborz Jahanianee9ca692010-03-15 18:36:00 +00002203 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2204 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002205 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
Fariborz Jahanianee9ca692010-03-15 18:36:00 +00002206 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
2207 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2208 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002209 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002210 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2211 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002212 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002213 return true;
2214 }
2215
2216 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
2217 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
2218 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
2219 // complain about it.
2220 IncompatibleObjC = true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002221 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002222 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2223 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002224 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002225 return true;
2226 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002227 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002228 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002229 QualType ToPointeeType;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002230 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002231 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002232 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002233 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian48168392010-01-21 00:08:17 +00002234 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002235 // to a block pointer type.
2236 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002237 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002238 return true;
2239 }
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002240 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002241 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002242 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
Fariborz Jahanianf7c43fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00002243 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002244 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
Fariborz Jahanian48168392010-01-21 00:08:17 +00002245 // pointer to any object.
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002246 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanianf7c43fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00002247 return true;
2248 }
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002249 else
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002250 return false;
2251
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002252 QualType FromPointeeType;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002253 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002254 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002255 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2256 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002257 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2258 else
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002259 return false;
2260
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002261 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
2262 // is an Objective-C conversion.
2263 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
2264 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2265 IncompatibleObjC)) {
2266 // We always complain about this conversion.
2267 IncompatibleObjC = true;
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002268 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002269 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002270 return true;
2271 }
Fariborz Jahanian83b7b312010-01-18 22:59:22 +00002272 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
2273 // as in I* to id.
2274 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2275 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2276 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2277 IncompatibleObjC)) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002278
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002279 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002280 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanian83b7b312010-01-18 22:59:22 +00002281 return true;
2282 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002283
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002284 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002285 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2286 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
2287 // complain about it).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002288 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002289 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002290 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002291 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002292 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
2293 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
2294 // Objective-C pointer conversion.
2295 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
2296 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
2297 return false;
2298
2299 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2300 // function types are obviously different.
2301 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
2302 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
2303 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
2304 return false;
2305
2306 bool HasObjCConversion = false;
2307 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getResultType())
2308 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
2309 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2310 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
2311 ToFunctionType->getResultType(),
2312 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2313 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2314 HasObjCConversion = true;
2315 } else {
2316 // Function types are too different. Abort.
2317 return false;
2318 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002319
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002320 // Check argument types.
2321 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
2322 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2323 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2324 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2325 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
2326 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
2327 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2328 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
2329 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2330 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2331 HasObjCConversion = true;
2332 } else {
2333 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2334 return false;
2335 }
2336 }
2337
2338 if (HasObjCConversion) {
2339 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
2340 // conversion, but complain about it.
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002341 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002342 IncompatibleObjC = true;
2343 return true;
2344 }
2345 }
2346
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002347 return false;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002348}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002349
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002350/// \brief Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion,
2351/// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting.
2352///
2353/// \param FromType The type we're converting form.
2354///
2355/// \param ToType The type we're converting to.
2356///
2357/// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying
2358/// this conversion.
2359bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2360 QualType &ConvertedType) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002361 if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount ||
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002362 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
2363 return false;
2364
2365 // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers).
2366 QualType ToPointee;
2367 if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2368 ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType();
2369 else
2370 return false;
2371
2372 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers();
2373 if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2374 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing ||
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002375 !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty())
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002376 return false;
2377
2378 // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak.
2379 QualType FromPointee;
2380 if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2381 FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType();
2382 else
2383 return false;
2384
2385 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers();
2386 if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2387 (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong &&
2388 FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak))
2389 return false;
2390
2391 // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers.
2392 FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing);
2393 if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
2394 return false;
2395
2396 // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they
2397 // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back
2398 // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds.
2399 FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2400
2401 // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible.
2402 ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2403 bool IncompatibleObjC;
2404 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee))
2405 FromPointee = ToPointee;
2406 else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee,
2407 IncompatibleObjC))
2408 return false;
2409
2410 /// \brief Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to
2411 /// __autoreleasing pointee.
2412 FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals);
2413 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee);
2414 return true;
2415}
2416
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002417bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2418 QualType& ConvertedType) {
2419 QualType ToPointeeType;
2420 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2421 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2422 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2423 else
2424 return false;
2425
2426 QualType FromPointeeType;
2427 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2428 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2429 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2430 else
2431 return false;
2432 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
2433 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2434 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
2435
2436 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2437 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2438 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2439 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2440
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002441 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
2442 return false;
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002443
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002444 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002445 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002446
2447 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2448 // function types are obviously different.
2449 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
2450 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
2451 return false;
2452
2453 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2454 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2455 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
2456 return false;
2457
2458 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Fariborz Jahanian462dae52011-02-13 20:11:42 +00002459 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
2460 ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002461 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2462 } else {
2463 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getResultType();
2464 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getResultType();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002465 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002466 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
2467 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
2468
2469 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
2470 // OK exact match.
2471 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
2472 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2473 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2474 return false;
2475 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2476 }
2477 else
2478 return false;
2479 }
2480
2481 // Check argument types.
2482 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
2483 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2484 IncompatibleObjC = false;
2485 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2486 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2487 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
2488 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2489 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
2490 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2491 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2492 return false;
2493 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2494 } else
2495 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2496 return false;
2497 }
Fariborz Jahanian78213e42011-09-28 21:52:05 +00002498 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
2499 !Context.FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(FromFunctionType,
2500 ToFunctionType))
2501 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianf9d95272011-09-28 20:22:05 +00002502
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002503 ConvertedType = ToType;
2504 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002505}
2506
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002507enum {
2508 ft_default,
2509 ft_different_class,
2510 ft_parameter_arity,
2511 ft_parameter_mismatch,
2512 ft_return_type,
2513 ft_qualifer_mismatch
2514};
2515
2516/// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing
2517/// function types. Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in
2518/// parameter types, and different return types.
2519void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag,
2520 QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
Richard Trieua6dc7ef2011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002521 // If either type is not valid, include no extra info.
2522 if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) {
2523 PDiag << ft_default;
2524 return;
2525 }
2526
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002527 // Get the function type from the pointers.
2528 if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) {
2529 const MemberPointerType *FromMember = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
2530 *ToMember = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2531 if (FromMember->getClass() != ToMember->getClass()) {
2532 PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0)
2533 << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0);
2534 return;
2535 }
2536 FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType();
2537 ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType();
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002538 }
2539
Richard Trieua6dc7ef2011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002540 if (FromType->isPointerType())
2541 FromType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2542 if (ToType->isPointerType())
2543 ToType = ToType->getPointeeType();
2544
2545 // Remove references.
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002546 FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType();
2547 ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
2548
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002549 // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions.
2550 if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() &&
2551 !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) {
2552 PDiag << ft_default;
2553 return;
2554 }
2555
Richard Trieua6dc7ef2011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002556 // No extra info for same types.
2557 if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) {
2558 PDiag << ft_default;
2559 return;
2560 }
2561
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002562 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(),
2563 *ToFunction = ToType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2564
2565 // Both types need to be function types.
2566 if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) {
2567 PDiag << ft_default;
2568 return;
2569 }
2570
2571 if (FromFunction->getNumArgs() != ToFunction->getNumArgs()) {
2572 PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumArgs()
2573 << FromFunction->getNumArgs();
2574 return;
2575 }
2576
2577 // Handle different parameter types.
2578 unsigned ArgPos;
2579 if (!FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) {
2580 PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1
2581 << ToFunction->getArgType(ArgPos)
2582 << FromFunction->getArgType(ArgPos);
2583 return;
2584 }
2585
2586 // Handle different return type.
2587 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getResultType(),
2588 ToFunction->getResultType())) {
2589 PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getResultType()
2590 << FromFunction->getResultType();
2591 return;
2592 }
2593
2594 unsigned FromQuals = FromFunction->getTypeQuals(),
2595 ToQuals = ToFunction->getTypeQuals();
2596 if (FromQuals != ToQuals) {
2597 PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToQuals << FromQuals;
2598 return;
2599 }
2600
2601 // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info.
2602 PDiag << ft_default;
2603}
2604
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002605/// FunctionArgTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
Douglas Gregordec1cc42011-12-15 17:15:07 +00002606/// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
Eli Friedman06017002013-06-18 22:41:37 +00002607/// they have same number of arguments. If the parameters are different,
2608/// ArgPos will have the parameter index of the first different parameter.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002609bool Sema::FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002610 const FunctionProtoType *NewType,
2611 unsigned *ArgPos) {
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002612 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
2613 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
2614 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
Eli Friedman06017002013-06-18 22:41:37 +00002615 if (!Context.hasSameType(*O, *N)) {
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002616 if (ArgPos) *ArgPos = O - OldType->arg_type_begin();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002617 return false;
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002618 }
2619 }
2620 return true;
2621}
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002622
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002623/// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
2624/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00002625/// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002626/// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
2627/// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
2628/// error, or returns false otherwise.
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002629bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002630 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002631 CXXCastPath& BasePath,
Sebastian Redla82e4ae2009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002632 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002633 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb3358722010-09-28 14:54:11 +00002634 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002635
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002636 Kind = CK_BitCast;
2637
David Blaikie50800fc2012-08-08 17:33:31 +00002638 if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && !FromType->isAnyPointerType() &&
2639 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) ==
2640 Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) {
2641 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy))
2642 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
2643 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
2644 << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
2645 else if (!isUnevaluatedContext())
2646 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_non_literal_null_pointer)
2647 << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2648 }
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002649 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2650 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002651 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
2652 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregordda78892008-12-18 23:43:31 +00002653
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002654 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2655 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002656 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
2657 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002658 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType,
2659 From->getExprLoc(),
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00002660 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath,
Sebastian Redla82e4ae2009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002661 IgnoreBaseAccess))
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002662 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002663
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002664 // The conversion was successful.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002665 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002666 }
2667 }
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002668 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
2669 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2670 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
2671 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002672 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
2673 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
2674 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002675 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002676 return false;
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002677 } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2678 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
2679 } else {
2680 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002681 }
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002682 } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2683 if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType())
2684 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002685 }
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002686
2687 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
2688 // reasons.
2689 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2690 Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
2691
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002692 return false;
2693}
2694
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002695/// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2696/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
2697/// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
2698/// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
2699/// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
2700bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002701 QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002702 bool InOverloadResolution,
2703 QualType &ConvertedType) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002704 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002705 if (!ToTypePtr)
2706 return false;
2707
2708 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002709 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2710 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2711 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002712 ConvertedType = ToType;
2713 return true;
2714 }
2715
2716 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002717 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002718 if (!FromTypePtr)
2719 return false;
2720
2721 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
2722 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
2723 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2724 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002725
Douglas Gregorcfddf7b2010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002726 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00002727 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorcfddf7b2010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002728 IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) {
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002729 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
2730 ToClass.getTypePtr());
2731 return true;
2732 }
2733
2734 return false;
2735}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002736
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002737/// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
2738/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
John McCall6b2accb2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002739/// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002740/// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
2741/// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
2742/// otherwise.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002743bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002744 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002745 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Sebastian Redla82e4ae2009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002746 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002747 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002748 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002749 if (!FromPtrType) {
2750 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002751 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002752 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002753 "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002754 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002755 return false;
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002756 }
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002757
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002758 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002759 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
2760 "that is not a member pointer.");
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002761
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002762 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
2763 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002764
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002765 // FIXME: What about dependent types?
2766 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
2767 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002768
Anders Carlssonf9d68e12010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002769 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
Douglas Gregora8f32e02009-10-06 17:59:45 +00002770 /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002771 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
2772 assert(DerivationOkay &&
2773 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
2774 (void)DerivationOkay;
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002775
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002776 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
2777 getUnqualifiedType())) {
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002778 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
2779 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
2780 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
2781 return true;
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002782 }
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002783
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002784 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002785 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
2786 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
2787 << From->getSourceRange();
2788 return true;
2789 }
2790
John McCall6b2accb2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002791 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
John McCall58e6f342010-03-16 05:22:47 +00002792 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
2793 Paths.front(),
2794 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
John McCall6b2accb2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002795
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002796 // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
Anders Carlssonf9d68e12010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002797 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002798 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002799 return false;
2800}
2801
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002802/// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
2803/// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
2804/// (C++ 4.4).
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002805///
2806/// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate
2807/// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C
2808/// object lifetime.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002809bool
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002810Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002811 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002812 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
2813 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002814 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
2815
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002816 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
2817 // qualification conversion.
Sebastian Redl22c92402010-02-03 19:36:07 +00002818 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002819 return false;
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002820
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002821 // (C++ 4.4p4):
2822 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
2823 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
2824 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002825 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002826 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002827 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2828 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2829 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregorf8268ae2008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002830 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002831 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
2832 // unwrap.
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002833 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002834
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002835 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
2836 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers();
2837
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002838 // Objective-C ARC:
2839 // Check Objective-C lifetime conversions.
2840 if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() &&
2841 UnwrappedAnyPointer) {
2842 if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) {
2843 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
2844 FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2845 ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2846 } else {
2847 // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different
2848 // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers.
2849 return false;
2850 }
2851 }
2852
Douglas Gregor377e1bd2011-05-08 06:09:53 +00002853 // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes.
2854 if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() &&
2855 (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) {
2856 FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2857 ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2858 }
2859
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002860 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
2861 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile.
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002862 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002863 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002864
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002865 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
2866 // every cv for 0 < k < j.
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002867 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002868 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002869 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002870
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002871 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
2872 // include const.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002873 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002874 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst();
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002875 }
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002876
2877 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
2878 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
2879 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
2880 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
2881 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00002882 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002883}
2884
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00002885/// \brief - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an
2886/// atomic type.
2887///
2888/// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion
2889/// sequence to finish the conversion.
Douglas Gregor7d000652012-04-12 20:48:09 +00002890static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2891 bool InOverloadResolution,
2892 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
2893 bool CStyle) {
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00002894 const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>();
2895 if (!ToAtomic)
2896 return false;
2897
2898 StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS;
2899 if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(),
2900 InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS,
2901 CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false))
2902 return false;
2903
2904 SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second;
2905 SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1));
2906 SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third;
2907 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
2908 = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime;
2909 SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2));
2910 return true;
2911}
2912
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002913static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context,
2914 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor,
2915 QualType Type) {
2916 const FunctionProtoType *CtorType =
2917 Constructor->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2918 if (CtorType->getNumArgs() > 0) {
2919 QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getArgType(0);
2920 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType()))
2921 return true;
2922 }
2923 return false;
2924}
2925
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002926static OverloadingResult
2927IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2928 CXXRecordDecl *To,
2929 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
2930 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
2931 bool AllowExplicit) {
David Blaikie3bc93e32012-12-19 00:45:41 +00002932 DeclContext::lookup_result R = S.LookupConstructors(To);
2933 for (DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con = R.begin(), ConEnd = R.end();
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002934 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
2935 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2936 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2937
2938 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
2939 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
2940 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
2941 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
2942 if (ConstructorTmpl)
2943 Constructor
2944 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2945 else
2946 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
2947
2948 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
2949 S.isInitListConstructor(Constructor) &&
2950 (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
2951 if (Usable) {
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002952 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
2953 // suppress conversions.
2954 bool SuppressUserConversions =
2955 isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(S.Context, Constructor, ToType);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002956 if (ConstructorTmpl)
2957 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
2958 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00002959 From, CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002960 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002961 else
2962 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00002963 From, CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002964 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002965 }
2966 }
2967
2968 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
2969
2970 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
2971 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
2972 case OR_Success: {
2973 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
2974 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002975 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
2976 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
2977 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
2978 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
2979 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
2980 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
2981 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
2982 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
2983 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
2984 return OR_Success;
2985 }
2986
2987 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
2988 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
2989 case OR_Deleted:
2990 return OR_Deleted;
2991 case OR_Ambiguous:
2992 return OR_Ambiguous;
2993 }
2994
2995 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
2996}
2997
Douglas Gregor734d9862009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002998/// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
2999/// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
3000/// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
3001/// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
3002/// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
3003/// false and User is unspecified.
3004///
Douglas Gregor734d9862009-01-30 23:27:23 +00003005/// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x
3006/// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
3007/// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003008static OverloadingResult
3009IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00003010 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
3011 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003012 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003013 // Whether we will only visit constructors.
3014 bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
3015
3016 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
3017 // constructors.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003018 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003019 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
3020 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
3021 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
3022 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
3023 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
3024 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
3025 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
3026 // the parentheses of the initializer.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003027 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003028 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003029 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType)))
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003030 ConstructorsOnly = true;
3031
Benjamin Kramer63b6ebe2012-11-23 17:04:52 +00003032 S.RequireCompleteType(From->getExprLoc(), ToType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidise36bca62011-04-22 17:45:37 +00003033 // RequireCompleteType may have returned true due to some invalid decl
3034 // during template instantiation, but ToType may be complete enough now
3035 // to try to recover.
3036 if (ToType->isIncompleteType()) {
Douglas Gregor393896f2009-11-05 13:06:35 +00003037 // We're not going to find any constructors.
3038 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
3039 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003040
3041 Expr **Args = &From;
3042 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
3043 bool ListInitializing = false;
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003044 if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) {
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00003045 // But first, see if there is an init-list-contructor that will work.
3046 OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(
3047 S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet, AllowExplicit);
3048 if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function)
3049 return Result;
3050 // Never mind.
3051 CandidateSet.clear();
3052
3053 // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as
3054 // arguments, not the entire list.
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003055 Args = InitList->getInits();
3056 NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits();
3057 ListInitializing = true;
3058 }
3059
David Blaikie3bc93e32012-12-19 00:45:41 +00003060 DeclContext::lookup_result R = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl);
3061 for (DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con = R.begin(), ConEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00003062 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003063 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
3064 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
3065
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003066 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
3067 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
3068 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003069 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003070 if (ConstructorTmpl)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003071 Constructor
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003072 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
3073 else
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003074 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003075
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003076 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl();
3077 if (ListInitializing)
3078 Usable = Usable && (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
3079 else
3080 Usable = Usable &&Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit);
3081 if (Usable) {
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003082 bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly;
3083 if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) {
3084 SuppressUserConversions = false;
3085 if (NumArgs == 1) {
3086 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
3087 // suppress conversions.
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00003088 SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(
3089 S.Context, Constructor, ToType);
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003090 }
3091 }
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003092 if (ConstructorTmpl)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003093 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
3094 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003095 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003096 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003097 else
Fariborz Jahanian249cead2009-10-01 20:39:51 +00003098 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
3099 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003100 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003101 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003102 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003103 }
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00003104 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003105 }
3106 }
3107
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003108 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003109 if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00003110 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(), 0)) {
Douglas Gregor5842ba92009-08-24 15:23:48 +00003111 // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003112 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003113 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003114 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003115 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
3116 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00003117 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
3118 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
3119 Conversions = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3120 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
3121 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003122 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
3123 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003124 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3125 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3126 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3127
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003128 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3129 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
John McCall32daa422010-03-31 01:36:47 +00003130 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
3131 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003132 else
John McCall32daa422010-03-31 01:36:47 +00003133 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003134
3135 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
3136 if (ConvTemplate)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003137 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
3138 ActingContext, From, ToType,
3139 CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003140 else
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003141 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
3142 From, ToType, CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003143 }
3144 }
3145 }
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003146 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003147
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003148 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3149
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003150 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00003151 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003152 case OR_Success:
3153 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
3154 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
3155 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3156 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3157 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3158 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
3159 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by
3160 // the argument of the constructor.
3161 //
3162 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003163 if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3164 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
3165 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
3166 } else {
3167 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
3168 User.EllipsisConversion = true;
3169 else {
3170 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3171 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
3172 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003173 }
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003174 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003175 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00003176 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003177 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3178 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
3179 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3180 return OR_Success;
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003181 }
3182 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003183 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3184 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3185 //
3186 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3187 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
3188 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the
3189 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
3190 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003191 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003192 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00003193 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003194 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003195
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003196 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
3197 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the
3198 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
3199 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
3200 // is an initialization, the special rules for
3201 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
3202 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
3203 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
3204 // 13.3.3.1).
3205 User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3206 return OR_Success;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003207 }
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003208 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003209
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003210 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3211 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3212 case OR_Deleted:
3213 // No conversion here! We're done.
3214 return OR_Deleted;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003215
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003216 case OR_Ambiguous:
3217 return OR_Ambiguous;
3218 }
3219
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003220 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003221}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003222
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003223bool
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003224Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003225 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00003226 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003227 OverloadingResult OvResult =
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003228 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003229 CandidateSet, false);
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003230 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00003231 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003232 diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
3233 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
Larisse Voufo7419d012013-06-27 01:50:25 +00003234 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty()) {
3235 if (!ToType->isIncompleteType() ||
3236 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType,
3237 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition_incomplete,
3238 From->getType(), From->getSourceRange()))
3239 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
3240 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
3241 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << ToType;
3242 }
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003243 else
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003244 return false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003245 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, From);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003246 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003247}
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003248
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003249/// \brief Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors
3250/// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering
3251/// is possible.
3252static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3253compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S,
3254 FunctionDecl *Function1,
3255 FunctionDecl *Function2) {
Richard Smith80ad52f2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00003256 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC1 || !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003257 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3258
3259 // Objective-C++:
3260 // If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from
3261 // a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer,
3262 // respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer,
3263 // because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely
3264 // to keep code working.
3265 CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1);
3266 if (!Conv1)
3267 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3268
3269 CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2);
3270 if (!Conv2)
3271 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3272
3273 if (Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() && Conv2->getParent()->isLambda()) {
3274 bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3275 bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3276 if (Block1 != Block2)
3277 return Block1? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3278 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3279 }
3280
3281 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3282}
3283
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003284/// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
3285/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3286/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003287static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3288CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3289 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
3290 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003291{
3292 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
3293 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
3294 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
3295 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
3296 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
3297 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
3298 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
3299 // (13.3.3.1.3).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003300 //
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003301 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
3302 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
3303 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
3304 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
3305 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003306 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
3307 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003308 if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003309 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003310
Benjamin Kramerb6eee072010-04-18 12:05:54 +00003311 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
3312 // the same kind.
3313 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
3314 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3315
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003316 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
3317 ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3318
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003319 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
3320 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
3321 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003322 if (ICS1.isStandard())
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003323 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3324 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003325 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003326 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
3327 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
3328 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
3329 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
3330 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
3331 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003332 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003333 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003334 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3335 ICS1.UserDefined.After,
3336 ICS2.UserDefined.After);
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003337 else
3338 Result = compareConversionFunctions(S,
3339 ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction,
3340 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003341 }
3342
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003343 // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than
3344 // list-initialization sequence L2 if L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X>
3345 // for some X and L2 does not.
3346 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable &&
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00003347 !ICS1.isBad() &&
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003348 ICS1.isListInitializationSequence() &&
3349 ICS2.isListInitializationSequence()) {
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00003350 if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3351 !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3352 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3353 if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3354 ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3355 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003356 }
3357
3358 return Result;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003359}
3360
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003361static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
3362 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
3363 Qualifiers Quals;
3364 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003365 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003366 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003367
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003368 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
3369}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003370
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003371// Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
3372// determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
3373static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3374compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
3375 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3376 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3377 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
3378 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3379
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003380 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
Douglas Gregorae65f4b2010-05-23 22:10:15 +00003381 // any non-identity conversion sequence
Douglas Gregor4ae5b722011-06-05 06:15:20 +00003382 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3383 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3384 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3385 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003386
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003387 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
3388 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
3389 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3390 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
3391 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3392 else
3393 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003394 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003395 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3396
3397 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
3398 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
3399 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3400 }
3401
3402 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
3403 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3404 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3405 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3406
3407 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
3408 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3409 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3410 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003411
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003412 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3413}
3414
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003415/// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
3416/// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
3417static bool isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
3418 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
3419 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3420 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
3421 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003422 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003423 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003424 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003425 // reference*.
3426 //
3427 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
3428 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
3429 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
3430 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
3431 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003432 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
3433 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
3434 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003435
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003436 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
3437 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
3438 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
3439 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference);
3440}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003441
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003442/// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
3443/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3444/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003445static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3446CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3447 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3448 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003449{
3450 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
3451 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3452
3453 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
3454 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
3455 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
3456 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
3457 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003458 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003459 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003460 return CK;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003461
3462 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
3463 // defined below), or, if not that,
3464 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
3465 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
3466 if (Rank1 < Rank2)
3467 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3468 else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
3469 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003470
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003471 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
3472 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
3473 // applies:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003474
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003475 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
3476 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
3477 // that is such a conversion.
3478 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
3479 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
3480 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3481 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3482
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003483 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
3484 //
3485 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003486 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
3487 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
3488 // of B* to void*.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003489 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003490 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003491 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003492 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003493 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3494 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
3495 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003496 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3497 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003498 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3499 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
3500 // their derived-to-base conversions.
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003501 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003502 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003503 return DerivedCK;
Douglas Gregor0f7b3dc2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003504 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid &&
3505 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) {
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003506 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
3507 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
3508 // inheritance relationship in their sources.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003509 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
3510 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003511
3512 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3513 // conversion, if we need to.
3514 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003515 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003516 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003517 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003518
Douglas Gregor0f7b3dc2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003519 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3520 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003521
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003522 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregor01919692009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003523 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003524 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregor01919692009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003525 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3526
3527 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
3528 // other, it is the better one.
Douglas Gregor0f7b3dc2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003529 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1
3530 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3531 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2
3532 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3533 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) {
3534 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1,
3535 FromObjCPtr2);
3536 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2,
3537 FromObjCPtr1);
3538 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) {
3539 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3540 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3541 }
Douglas Gregor01919692009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003542 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003543 }
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003544
3545 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
3546 // bullet 3).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003547 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003548 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003549 return QualCK;
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003550
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003551 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003552 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
3553 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
3554 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3555 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
3556 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003557
Sebastian Redlf2e21e52009-03-22 23:49:27 +00003558 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3559 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
3560 // which the references refer are the same type except for
3561 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
3562 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
3563 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003564 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3565 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003566 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3567 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003568 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003569 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3570 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003571 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003572 // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different
3573 // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime.
3574 if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding !=
3575 SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) {
3576 return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding
3577 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3578 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3579 }
3580
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003581 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
3582 // type for comparison.
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003583 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003584 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003585 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003586 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003587 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
3588 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3589 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003590 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003591 }
3592 }
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003593
Francois Pichet1c98d622011-09-18 21:37:37 +00003594 // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a
3595 // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion
3596 // is between types of the same size.
3597 // For example:
3598 // void f(float);
3599 // void f(int);
3600 // int main {
3601 // long a;
3602 // f(a);
3603 // }
3604 // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error
3605 // as clang will do in standard mode.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00003606 if (S.getLangOpts().MicrosoftMode &&
Francois Pichet1c98d622011-09-18 21:37:37 +00003607 SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion &&
3608 SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral &&
3609 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) ==
3610 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2)))
3611 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3612
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003613 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3614}
3615
3616/// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3617/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003618/// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
3619ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003620CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
3621 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3622 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
Douglas Gregorba7e2102008-10-22 15:04:37 +00003623 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003624 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
3625 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
3626 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
3627 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
3628 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
3629 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
3630 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
3631 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3632
3633 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
3634 // conversion (!)
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003635 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3636 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003637 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3638 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003639 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003640 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3641 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003642
3643 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
3644 // them.
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003645 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003646 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3647
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003648 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3649 // for comparison.
3650 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003651 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003652 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003653 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003654
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003655 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003656 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003657
3658 // Objective-C++ ARC:
3659 // Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime
3660 // to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime.
3661 if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime !=
3662 SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) {
3663 Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
3664 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3665 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3666 }
3667
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003668 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003669 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
3670 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
3671 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregorf8268ae2008-10-22 17:49:05 +00003672 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003673 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
3674 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
3675 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
3676 // strict subset of qualifiers.
3677 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
3678 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
3679 // about how the sequences rank.
3680 ;
3681 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
3682 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3683 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
3684 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3685 // qualifiers.
3686 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003687
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003688 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3689 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
3690 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3691 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
3692 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3693 // qualifiers.
3694 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003695
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003696 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3697 } else {
3698 // Qualifiers are disjoint.
3699 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3700 }
3701
3702 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003703 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003704 break;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003705 }
3706
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003707 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
3708 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
3709 switch (Result) {
3710 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00003711 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003712 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3713 break;
3714
3715 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
3716 break;
3717
3718 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00003719 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003720 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3721 break;
3722 }
3723
3724 return Result;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003725}
3726
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003727/// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3728/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003729/// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
3730/// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at
3731/// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003732ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003733CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
3734 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3735 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003736 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003737 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003738 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003739 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003740
3741 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3742 // conversion, if we need to.
3743 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003744 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003745 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003746 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003747
3748 // Canonicalize all of the types.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003749 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
3750 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
3751 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
3752 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003753
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003754 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003755 //
3756 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
3757 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003758 //
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003759 // Compare based on pointer conversions.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003760 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
Douglas Gregor7ca09762008-11-27 01:19:21 +00003761 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3762 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
3763 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
3764 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003765 QualType FromPointee1
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003766 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003767 QualType ToPointee1
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003768 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003769 QualType FromPointee2
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003770 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003771 QualType ToPointee2
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003772 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003773
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003774 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003775 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003776 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003777 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003778 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003779 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3780 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003781
3782 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
3783 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003784 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003785 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003786 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003787 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor395cc372011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003788 }
3789 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3790 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
3791 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
3792 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3793 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
3794 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3795 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
3796 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3797 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
3798 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3799
3800 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
3801 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
3802 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
3803 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
3804 // Objective-C pointer types.
3805 bool FromAssignLeft
3806 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
3807 bool FromAssignRight
3808 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
3809 bool ToAssignLeft
3810 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
3811 bool ToAssignRight
3812 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
3813
3814 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
3815 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
3816 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
3817 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3818 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3819 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
3820 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3821 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3822
3823 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
3824 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
3825 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3826 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3827 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3828 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3829
3830 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
3831 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
3832 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3833 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3834 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3835 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
3836 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3837 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3838
3839 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
3840 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
3841 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3842 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3843 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3844 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003845
Douglas Gregor395cc372011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003846 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3847 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3848 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3849 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight))
3850 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3851 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3852
3853 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3854 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
3855 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
3856 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3857 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003858 }
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003859 }
Douglas Gregor395cc372011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003860
Fariborz Jahanian2357da02009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003861 // Ranking of member-pointer types.
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003862 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
3863 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
3864 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003865 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003866 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003867 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003868 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003869 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003870 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003871 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003872 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3873 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
3874 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
3875 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
3876 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
3877 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3878 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3879 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3880 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanian2357da02009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003881 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003882 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003883 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003884 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003885 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003886 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3887 }
3888 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
3889 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003890 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003891 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003892 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003893 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3894 }
3895 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003896
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003897 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003898 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
Douglas Gregor9e239322010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003899 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
3900 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3901 // reference of type A&,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003902 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3903 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3904 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003905 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003906 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003907 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3908 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003909
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003910 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
Douglas Gregor9e239322010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003911 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
3912 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3913 // reference of type A&,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003914 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3915 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3916 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003917 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003918 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003919 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3920 }
3921 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003922
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003923 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3924}
3925
Douglas Gregor0162c1c2013-03-26 23:36:30 +00003926/// \brief Determine whether the given type is valid, e.g., it is not an invalid
3927/// C++ class.
3928static bool isTypeValid(QualType T) {
3929 if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = T->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3930 return !Record->isInvalidDecl();
3931
3932 return true;
3933}
3934
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003935/// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
3936/// determine whether they are reference-related,
3937/// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
3938/// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
3939/// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
3940/// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
3941/// type being initialized.
3942Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
3943Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
3944 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003945 bool &DerivedToBase,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003946 bool &ObjCConversion,
3947 bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003948 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
3949 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
3950 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
3951
3952 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
3953 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
3954 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3955 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3956 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3957
3958 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3959 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
3960 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
3961 // T1 is a base class of T2.
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003962 DerivedToBase = false;
3963 ObjCConversion = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003964 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003965 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
3966 // Nothing to do.
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00003967 } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregor0162c1c2013-03-26 23:36:30 +00003968 isTypeValid(UnqualT1) && isTypeValid(UnqualT2) &&
3969 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003970 DerivedToBase = true;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003971 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3972 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3973 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
3974 ObjCConversion = true;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003975 else
3976 return Ref_Incompatible;
3977
3978 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
3979 // least).
3980
3981 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3982 // for comparison.
3983 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
3984 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
3985 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
3986 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
3987
3988 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3989 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
3990 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
3991 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
3992 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
3993 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
3994 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
Douglas Gregora6ce3e62011-04-28 17:56:11 +00003995 //
3996 // Note that we also require equivalence of Objective-C GC and address-space
3997 // qualifiers when performing these computations, so that e.g., an int in
3998 // address space 1 is not reference-compatible with an int in address
3999 // space 2.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004000 if (T1Quals.getObjCLifetime() != T2Quals.getObjCLifetime() &&
4001 T1Quals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(T2Quals)) {
4002 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4003 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4004 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
4005 }
4006
Douglas Gregora6ce3e62011-04-28 17:56:11 +00004007 if (T1Quals == T2Quals)
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004008 return Ref_Compatible;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004009 else if (T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004010 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification;
4011 else
4012 return Ref_Related;
4013}
4014
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004015/// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004016/// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
4017static bool
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004018FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
4019 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4020 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
4021 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004022 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
4023 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
4024 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
4025
4026 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00004027 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
4028 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
4029 Conversions = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
4030 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
4031 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004032 NamedDecl *D = *I;
4033 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
4034 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4035 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
4036
4037 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
4038 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
4039 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
4040 if (ConvTemplate)
4041 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
4042 else
4043 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
4044
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004045 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004046 // explicit conversions, skip it.
4047 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit())
4048 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004049
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004050 if (AllowRvalues) {
4051 bool DerivedToBase = false;
4052 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004053 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor203050c2011-10-04 23:59:32 +00004054
4055 // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion
4056 // functions that return lvalues.
4057 if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4058 const ReferenceType *RefType
4059 = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
4060 if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
4061 continue;
4062 }
4063
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004064 if (!ConvTemplate &&
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00004065 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
4066 DeclLoc,
4067 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
4068 .getUnqualifiedType(),
4069 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(),
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004070 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion) ==
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00004071 Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004072 continue;
4073 } else {
4074 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
4075 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
4076 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
4077
4078 const ReferenceType *RefType =
4079 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
4080 if (!RefType ||
4081 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
4082 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
4083 continue;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004084 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004085
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004086 if (ConvTemplate)
4087 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004088 Init, DeclType, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004089 else
4090 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004091 DeclType, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004092 }
4093
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00004094 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
4095
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004096 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00004097 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004098 case OR_Success:
4099 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
4100 //
4101 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
4102 // applying a conversion function to the argument
4103 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
4104 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
4105 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity
4106 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
4107 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
4108 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
4109 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
4110 return false;
4111
4112 ICS.setUserDefined();
4113 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
4114 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00004115 ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004116 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00004117 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004118 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
4119 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
4120 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
4121 "Expected a direct reference binding!");
4122 return true;
4123
4124 case OR_Ambiguous:
4125 ICS.setAmbiguous();
4126 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
4127 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
4128 if (Cand->Viable)
4129 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
4130 return true;
4131
4132 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
4133 case OR_Deleted:
4134 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
4135 // conversion; continue with other checks.
4136 return false;
4137 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004138
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00004139 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004140}
4141
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004142/// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
4143/// initialization.
4144static ImplicitConversionSequence
Sebastian Redl1cdb70b2011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004145TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType,
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004146 SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4147 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregor23ef6c02010-04-16 17:45:54 +00004148 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004149 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
4150
4151 // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
4152 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
4153 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4154
4155 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4156 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4157
4158 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4159 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4160 // type of the resulting function.
4161 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4162 DeclAccessPair Found;
4163 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
4164 false, Found))
4165 T2 = Fn->getType();
4166 }
4167
4168 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4169 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
4170 bool DerivedToBase = false;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004171 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004172 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004173 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004174 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004175 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004176 ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004177
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004178
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004179 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
Douglas Gregor66821b52010-04-18 09:22:00 +00004180 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
4181 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
4182
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004183 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004184 if (!isRValRef) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004185 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
4186 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
4187 //
4188 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
4189 if (InitCategory.isLValue() &&
4190 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004191 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004192 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
4193 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
4194 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
4195 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
4196 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
4197 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
4198 ICS.setStandard();
4199 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004200 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
4201 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4202 : ICK_Identity;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004203 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4204 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4205 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4206 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4207 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4208 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4209 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004210 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4211 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4212 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004213 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004214 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004215 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004216
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004217 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
4218 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
4219 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
4220 // [over.best.ics]p2).
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004221 return ICS;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004222 }
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004223
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004224 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
4225 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
4226 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
4227 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
4228 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
4229 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
4230 // one through overload resolution (13.3)),
4231 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004232 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004233 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004234 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4235 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
4236 AllowExplicit))
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004237 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004238 }
4239 }
4240
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004241 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
4242 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004243 // shall be an rvalue reference.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004244 //
Douglas Gregor66821b52010-04-18 09:22:00 +00004245 // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this
4246 // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference
4247 // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct
4248 // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile
4249 // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence
4250 // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only
4251 // qualifier.
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004252 // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer
4253 // go together.
Richard Smith8ab10aa2012-05-24 04:29:20 +00004254 if (!isRValRef && (!T1.isConstQualified() || T1.isVolatileQualified()))
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004255 return ICS;
4256
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004257 // -- If the initializer expression
4258 //
4259 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004260 // lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004261 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification &&
4262 (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
4263 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
4264 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
4265 ICS.setStandard();
4266 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004267 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004268 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4269 : ICK_Identity;
4270 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4271 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4272 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4273 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4274 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4275 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4276 // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
4277 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
4278 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
4279 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
4280 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004281 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding =
Richard Smith80ad52f2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00004282 S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ||
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004283 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && !T2->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004284 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4285 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004286 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004287 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004288 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004289 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004290 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004291 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004292
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004293 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
4294 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004295 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
4296 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004297 // "cv3 T3",
4298 //
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004299 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004300 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004301 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004302 // class subobject).
4303 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004304 T2->isRecordType() && !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004305 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4306 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
4307 AllowExplicit)) {
4308 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
4309 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
4310 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
4311 // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004312 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004313 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
4314 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4315
Douglas Gregor68ed68b2011-01-21 16:36:05 +00004316 return ICS;
Rafael Espindolaaa5952c2011-01-22 15:32:35 +00004317 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004318
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004319 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
4320 // initialized from the initializer expression using the
4321 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
4322 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
4323 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
4324 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
4325 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
4326 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
4327 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
4328 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
4329 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
4330 // initialization fails.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004331 //
4332 // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here.
4333 // ObjC GC and lifetime qualifiers aren't important.
4334 Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers();
4335 Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers();
4336 T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4337 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4338 T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4339 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4340 if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
4341 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004342 }
4343
4344 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
4345 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
4346 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
4347 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
4348 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
4349 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4350 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
4351 return ICS;
4352
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004353 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
4354 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
4355 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related &&
4356 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue())
4357 return ICS;
4358
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004359 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004360 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
4361 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
4362 // required to convert the argument expression to the
4363 // underlying type of the reference according to
4364 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
4365 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
4366 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
4367 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
4368 // and does not constitute a conversion.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004369 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4370 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004371 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004372 /*CStyle=*/false,
4373 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004374
4375 // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
4376 if (ICS.isStandard()) {
4377 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004378 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4379 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4380 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004381 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004382 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004383 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor203050c2011-10-04 23:59:32 +00004384 // Don't allow rvalue references to bind to lvalues.
4385 if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4386 if (const ReferenceType *RefType
4387 = ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getResultType()
4388 ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
4389 if (!RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) {
4390 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init,
4391 DeclType);
4392 return ICS;
4393 }
4394 }
4395 }
4396
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004397 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregorf20d2722011-08-15 13:59:46 +00004398 ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4399 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4400 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = true;
4401 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4402 ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004403 }
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004404
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004405 return ICS;
4406}
4407
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004408static ImplicitConversionSequence
4409TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4410 bool SuppressUserConversions,
4411 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004412 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4413 bool AllowExplicit = false);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004414
4415/// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the
4416/// initializer list From.
4417static ImplicitConversionSequence
4418TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType,
4419 bool SuppressUserConversions,
4420 bool InOverloadResolution,
4421 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
4422 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1:
4423 // When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and
4424 // special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type.
4425
4426 ImplicitConversionSequence Result;
4427 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004428 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004429
Sebastian Redlb832f6d2012-01-23 22:09:39 +00004430 // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004431 // initialized from init lists.
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00004432 if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, 0))
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004433 return Result;
4434
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004435 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2:
4436 // If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and
4437 // all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit
4438 // conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an
4439 // element of the list to X.
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004440 bool toStdInitializerList = false;
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004441 QualType X;
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004442 if (ToType->isArrayType())
Richard Smith2801d9a2012-12-09 06:48:56 +00004443 X = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)->getElementType();
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004444 else
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004445 toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X);
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004446 if (!X.isNull()) {
4447 for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) {
4448 Expr *Init = From->getInit(i);
4449 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4450 TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions,
4451 InOverloadResolution,
4452 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4453 // If a single element isn't convertible, fail.
4454 if (ICS.isBad()) {
4455 Result = ICS;
4456 break;
4457 }
4458 // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion.
4459 if (Result.isBad() ||
4460 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, ICS, Result) ==
4461 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
4462 Result = ICS;
4463 }
Douglas Gregor5b4bf132012-04-04 23:09:20 +00004464
4465 // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence.
4466 // Introduce the identity conversion sequence.
4467 if (From->getNumInits() == 0) {
4468 Result.setStandard();
4469 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4470 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4471 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
4472 }
4473
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004474 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004475 Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004476 return Result;
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004477 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004478
4479 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3:
4480 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload
4481 // resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit
4482 // conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple
4483 // constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the
4484 // implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00004485 if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) {
4486 // This function can deal with initializer lists.
4487 Result = TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4488 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4489 InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false,
4490 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4491 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004492 return Result;
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00004493 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004494
4495 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4:
4496 // Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be
4497 // initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion
4498 // sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004499 if (ToType->isAggregateType()) {
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004500 // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes
4501 // down to checking whether the initialization works.
4502 // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not.
4503 InitializedEntity Entity =
4504 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
4505 /*Consumed=*/false);
4506 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, S.Owned(From))) {
4507 Result.setUserDefined();
4508 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
4509 // Initializer lists don't have a type.
4510 Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType());
4511 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType());
4512
4513 Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
4514 Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType);
4515 Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Benjamin Kramer83db10e2012-02-02 19:35:29 +00004516 Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = 0;
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004517 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004518 return Result;
4519 }
4520
4521 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5:
4522 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4.
Sebastian Redl1cdb70b2011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004523 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) {
4524 // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't
4525 // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list-
4526 // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that.
4527
4528 QualType T1 = ToType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4529
4530 // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related
4531 // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that.
4532 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
4533 Expr *Init = From->getInit(0);
4534
4535 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4536
4537 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4538 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4539 // type of the resulting function.
4540 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4541 DeclAccessPair Found;
4542 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(
4543 Init, ToType, false, Found))
4544 T2 = Fn->getType();
4545 }
4546
4547 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4548 bool dummy1 = false;
4549 bool dummy2 = false;
4550 bool dummy3 = false;
4551 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
4552 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getLocStart(), T1, T2, dummy1,
4553 dummy2, dummy3);
4554
4555 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related)
4556 return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType,
4557 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
4558 SuppressUserConversions,
4559 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
4560 }
4561
4562 // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the
4563 // initializer list.
4564 Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4565 InOverloadResolution,
4566 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4567 if (Result.isFailure())
4568 return Result;
4569 assert(!Result.isEllipsis() &&
4570 "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion.");
4571
4572 // Can we even bind to a temporary?
4573 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() ||
4574 (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) {
4575 StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard :
4576 Result.UserDefined.After;
4577 SCS.ReferenceBinding = true;
4578 SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType();
4579 SCS.BindsToRvalue = true;
4580 SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4581 SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4582 SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4583 } else
4584 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue,
4585 From, ToType);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004586 return Result;
Sebastian Redl1cdb70b2011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004587 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004588
4589 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6:
4590 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class:
4591 if (!ToType->isRecordType()) {
4592 // - if the initializer list has one element, the implicit conversion
4593 // sequence is the one required to convert the element to the
4594 // parameter type.
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004595 unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits();
4596 if (NumInits == 1)
4597 Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
4598 SuppressUserConversions,
4599 InOverloadResolution,
4600 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4601 // - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion
4602 // sequence is the identity conversion.
4603 else if (NumInits == 0) {
4604 Result.setStandard();
4605 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
John McCalle14ba2c2012-04-04 02:40:27 +00004606 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4607 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004608 }
Sebastian Redl2422e822012-02-28 23:36:38 +00004609 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004610 return Result;
4611 }
4612
4613 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7:
4614 // In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible
4615 return Result;
4616}
4617
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00004618/// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
4619/// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
4620/// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
4621/// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00004622/// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
Douglas Gregor74e386e2010-04-16 18:00:29 +00004623/// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004624static ImplicitConversionSequence
4625TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004626 bool SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004627 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004628 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4629 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004630 if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From))
4631 return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4632 InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4633
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004634 if (ToType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004635 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004636 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
4637 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004638 AllowExplicit);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004639
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004640 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
4641 SuppressUserConversions,
4642 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004643 InOverloadResolution,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004644 /*CStyle=*/false,
4645 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00004646}
4647
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00004648static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy,
4649 const CanQualType ToQTy,
4650 Sema &S,
4651 SourceLocation Loc,
4652 ExprValueKind FromVK) {
4653 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK);
4654 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4655 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false);
4656
4657 return !ICS.isBad();
4658}
4659
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004660/// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
4661/// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
4662/// expression @p From.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004663static ImplicitConversionSequence
Richard Smith98bfbf52013-01-26 02:07:32 +00004664TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType FromType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004665 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004666 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
4667 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
4668 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
Sebastian Redl65bdbfa2009-11-18 20:55:52 +00004669 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
4670 // const volatile object.
4671 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
4672 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004673 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004674
4675 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
4676 // to exit early.
4677 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004678
4679 // We need to have an object of class type.
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004680 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004681 FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
4682
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004683 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
4684 // better have an lvalue.
4685 assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
4686 }
4687
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004688 assert(FromType->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004689
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004690 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004691 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004692 // parameter is
4693 //
NAKAMURA Takumi00995302011-01-27 07:09:49 +00004694 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
4695 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
4696 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004697 // ref-qualifier
4698 //
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004699 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004700 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
4701 //
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004702 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004703 // are not allowed to create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004704 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
4705 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
4706 // non-constant references.
4707
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004708 // First check the qualifiers.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004709 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004710 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004711 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004712 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004713 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
Richard Smith98bfbf52013-01-26 02:07:32 +00004714 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004715 return ICS;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004716 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004717
4718 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
4719 // affects the conversion rank.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004720 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004721 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
4722 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
4723 SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004724 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType))
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004725 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004726 else {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004727 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
4728 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004729 return ICS;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004730 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004731
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004732 // Check the ref-qualifier.
4733 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
4734 case RQ_None:
4735 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
4736 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004737
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004738 case RQ_LValue:
4739 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) {
4740 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004741 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004742 ImplicitParamType);
4743 return ICS;
4744 }
4745 break;
4746
4747 case RQ_RValue:
4748 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
4749 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004750 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004751 ImplicitParamType);
4752 return ICS;
4753 }
4754 break;
4755 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004756
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004757 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004758 ICS.setStandard();
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004759 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4760 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004761 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00004762 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004763 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4764 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004765 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004766 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004767 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
4768 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
4769 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004770 return ICS;
4771}
4772
4773/// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
4774/// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
4775/// expression.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004776ExprResult
4777Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004778 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00004779 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00004780 CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004781 QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004782 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004783 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004784
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004785 Expr::Classification FromClassification;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004786 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004787 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
4788 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004789 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004790 } else {
4791 FromRecordType = From->getType();
4792 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004793 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004794 }
4795
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004796 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
4797 // the actual argument initialization.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004798 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004799 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), FromClassification,
4800 Method, Method->getParent());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004801 if (ICS.isBad()) {
4802 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) {
4803 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
4804 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
4805 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
4806 if (CVR) {
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004807 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004808 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
4809 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
4810 << From->getSourceRange();
4811 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
4812 << Method->getDeclName();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004813 return ExprError();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004814 }
4815 }
4816
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004817 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004818 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init)
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004819 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004820 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004821
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004822 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
4823 ExprResult FromRes =
4824 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
4825 if (FromRes.isInvalid())
4826 return ExprError();
4827 From = FromRes.take();
4828 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004829
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00004830 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004831 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp,
Richard Smithacdfa4d2011-11-10 23:32:36 +00004832 From->getValueKind()).take();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004833 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004834}
4835
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004836/// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
4837/// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004838static ImplicitConversionSequence
4839TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
Douglas Gregorc6dfe192010-05-08 22:41:50 +00004840 // FIXME: This is pretty broken.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004841 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
Anders Carlssonda7a18b2009-08-27 17:24:15 +00004842 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
4843 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004844 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004845 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004846 /*CStyle=*/false,
4847 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004848}
4849
4850/// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
4851/// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004852ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +00004853 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4854 return ExprError();
4855
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004856 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004857 if (!ICS.isBad())
4858 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004859
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00004860 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004861 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00004862 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00004863 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004864 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004865}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004866
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004867/// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant
4868/// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion
4869/// is acceptable.
4870static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S,
4871 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
4872 // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration
4873 // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third
4874 // conversions are fine.
4875 switch (SCS.Second) {
4876 case ICK_Identity:
4877 case ICK_Integral_Promotion:
4878 case ICK_Integral_Conversion:
Guy Benyei6959acd2013-02-07 16:05:33 +00004879 case ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion:
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004880 return true;
4881
4882 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
Richard Smith2bcb9842012-09-13 22:00:12 +00004883 // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is
4884 // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also an integral
4885 // conversion, so it's permitted in a converted constant expression.
4886 return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
4887 SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType();
4888
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004889 case ICK_Floating_Integral:
4890 case ICK_Complex_Real:
4891 return false;
4892
4893 case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue:
4894 case ICK_Array_To_Pointer:
4895 case ICK_Function_To_Pointer:
4896 case ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment:
4897 case ICK_Qualification:
4898 case ICK_Compatible_Conversion:
4899 case ICK_Vector_Conversion:
4900 case ICK_Vector_Splat:
4901 case ICK_Derived_To_Base:
4902 case ICK_Pointer_Conversion:
4903 case ICK_Pointer_Member:
4904 case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion:
4905 case ICK_Writeback_Conversion:
4906 case ICK_Floating_Promotion:
4907 case ICK_Complex_Promotion:
4908 case ICK_Complex_Conversion:
4909 case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
4910 case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion:
4911 llvm_unreachable("unexpected second conversion kind");
4912
4913 case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds:
4914 break;
4915 }
4916
4917 llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind");
4918}
4919
4920/// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a
4921/// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce
4922/// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3.
4923ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
4924 llvm::APSInt &Value,
4925 CCEKind CCE) {
Richard Smith80ad52f2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00004926 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus11 && "converted constant expression outside C++11");
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004927 assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type");
4928
4929 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4930 return ExprError();
4931
4932 // C++11 [expr.const]p3 with proposed wording fixes:
4933 // A converted constant expression of type T is a core constant expression,
4934 // implicitly converted to a prvalue of type T, where the converted
4935 // expression is a literal constant expression and the implicit conversion
4936 // sequence contains only user-defined conversions, lvalue-to-rvalue
4937 // conversions, integral promotions, and integral conversions other than
4938 // narrowing conversions.
4939 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4940 TryImplicitConversion(From, T,
4941 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
4942 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4943 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4944 /*CStyle=*/false,
4945 /*AllowObjcWritebackConversion=*/false);
4946 StandardConversionSequence *SCS = 0;
4947 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
4948 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
4949 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.Standard))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004950 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004951 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
4952 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4953 SCS = &ICS.Standard;
4954 break;
4955 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
4956 // We are converting from class type to an integral or enumeration type, so
4957 // the Before sequence must be trivial.
4958 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.UserDefined.After))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004959 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004960 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
4961 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4962 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After;
4963 break;
4964 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
4965 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
4966 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004967 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004968 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression)
4969 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4970 return ExprError();
4971
4972 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
4973 llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression");
4974 }
4975
4976 ExprResult Result = PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, AA_Converting);
4977 if (Result.isInvalid())
4978 return Result;
4979
4980 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion.
4981 APValue PreNarrowingValue;
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +00004982 QualType PreNarrowingType;
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +00004983 switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue,
4984 PreNarrowingType)) {
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004985 case NK_Variable_Narrowing:
4986 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant
4987 // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment.
4988 case NK_Not_Narrowing:
4989 break;
4990
4991 case NK_Constant_Narrowing:
Eli Friedman1ef28db2012-03-29 23:39:39 +00004992 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
4993 isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_cce_narrowing_sfinae :
4994 diag::err_cce_narrowing)
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004995 << CCE << /*Constant*/1
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +00004996 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(Context, PreNarrowingType) << T;
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004997 break;
4998
4999 case NK_Type_Narrowing:
Eli Friedman1ef28db2012-03-29 23:39:39 +00005000 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
5001 isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_cce_narrowing_sfinae :
5002 diag::err_cce_narrowing)
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005003 << CCE << /*Constant*/0 << From->getType() << T;
5004 break;
5005 }
5006
5007 // Check the expression is a constant expression.
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005008 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005009 Expr::EvalResult Eval;
5010 Eval.Diag = &Notes;
5011
Douglas Gregor484f6fa2013-04-08 23:24:07 +00005012 if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsRValue(Eval, Context) || !Eval.Val.isInt()) {
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005013 // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in
5014 // the AST.
5015 Result = ExprError();
Richard Smithf72fccf2012-01-30 22:27:01 +00005016 } else {
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005017 Value = Eval.Val.getInt();
Richard Smithf72fccf2012-01-30 22:27:01 +00005018
5019 if (Notes.empty()) {
5020 // It's a constant expression.
5021 return Result;
5022 }
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005023 }
5024
5025 // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic.
5026 if (Notes.size() == 1 &&
5027 Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr)
5028 Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE;
5029 else {
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00005030 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_expr_not_cce)
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005031 << CCE << From->getSourceRange();
5032 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I)
5033 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
5034 }
Richard Smithf72fccf2012-01-30 22:27:01 +00005035 return Result;
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005036}
5037
John McCall0bcc9bc2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005038/// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence
5039/// involves any pointer conversions, remove them. This may change
5040/// the result type of the conversion sequence.
5041static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
5042 if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
5043 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
5044 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
5045 SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0];
5046 }
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005047}
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005048
John McCall0bcc9bc2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005049/// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually
5050/// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5051static ImplicitConversionSequence
5052TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
5053 // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'.
5054 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
5055 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
5056 = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
5057 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
5058 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5059 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
5060 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5061 /*CStyle=*/false,
5062 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
5063
5064 // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'.
5065 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5066 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5067 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5068 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5069 break;
5070
5071 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5072 dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After);
5073 break;
5074
5075 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5076 dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard);
5077 break;
5078 }
5079
5080 return ICS;
5081}
5082
5083/// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual
5084/// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5085ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) {
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +00005086 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
5087 return ExprError();
5088
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005089 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall0bcc9bc2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005090 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5091 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From);
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005092 if (!ICS.isBad())
5093 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00005094 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005095}
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005096
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005097/// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration
5098/// type of a permitted flavor.
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005099bool Sema::ICEConvertDiagnoser::match(QualType T) {
5100 return AllowScopedEnumerations ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()
5101 : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005102}
5103
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005104static ExprResult
5105diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
5106 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5107 QualType T, UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions) {
5108
5109 if (Converter.Suppress)
5110 return ExprError();
5111
5112 Converter.diagnoseAmbiguous(SemaRef, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
5113 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5114 CXXConversionDecl *Conv =
5115 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
5116 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5117 Converter.noteAmbiguous(SemaRef, Conv, ConvTy);
5118 }
5119 return SemaRef.Owned(From);
5120}
5121
5122static bool
5123diagnoseNoViableConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From,
5124 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5125 QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
5126 UnresolvedSetImpl &ExplicitConversions) {
5127 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Converter.Suppress) {
5128 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
5129 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
5130 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5131
5132 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
5133 // conversion; use it.
5134 QualType ConvTy = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5135 std::string TypeStr;
5136 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, SemaRef.getPrintingPolicy());
5137
5138 Converter.diagnoseExplicitConv(SemaRef, Loc, T, ConvTy)
5139 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
5140 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
5141 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(
5142 SemaRef.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()), ")");
5143 Converter.noteExplicitConv(SemaRef, Conversion, ConvTy);
5144
5145 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
5146 // explicit conversion function.
5147 if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext())
5148 return true;
5149
5150 SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
5151 ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5152 HadMultipleCandidates);
5153 if (Result.isInvalid())
5154 return true;
5155 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5156 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5157 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(), 0,
5158 Result.get()->getValueKind());
5159 }
5160 return false;
5161}
5162
5163static bool recordConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From,
5164 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5165 QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
5166 DeclAccessPair &Found) {
5167 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
5168 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5169 SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
5170
5171 QualType ToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5172 if (!Converter.SuppressConversion) {
5173 if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext())
5174 return true;
5175
5176 Converter.diagnoseConversion(SemaRef, Loc, T, ToType)
5177 << From->getSourceRange();
5178 }
5179
5180 ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5181 HadMultipleCandidates);
5182 if (Result.isInvalid())
5183 return true;
5184 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5185 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5186 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(), 0,
5187 Result.get()->getValueKind());
5188 return false;
5189}
5190
5191static ExprResult finishContextualImplicitConversion(
5192 Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
5193 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) {
5194 if (!Converter.match(From->getType()) && !Converter.Suppress)
5195 Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(SemaRef, Loc, From->getType())
5196 << From->getSourceRange();
5197
5198 return SemaRef.DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
5199}
5200
5201static void
5202collectViableConversionCandidates(Sema &SemaRef, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5203 UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions,
5204 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
5205 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5206 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = ViableConversions[I];
5207 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
5208 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
5209 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
5210 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
5211
5212 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
5213 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
5214 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
5215 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
5216 else
5217 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
5218
5219 if (ConvTemplate)
5220 SemaRef.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(
5221 ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, CandidateSet);
5222 else
5223 SemaRef.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From,
5224 ToType, CandidateSet);
5225 }
5226}
5227
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005228/// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to a type which is accepted
5229/// by the given converter.
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005230///
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005231/// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to a
5232/// type accepted by the specified converter. In C++11 and before, the class
5233/// must have a single non-explicit conversion function converting to a matching
5234/// type. In C++1y, there can be multiple such conversion functions, but only
5235/// one target type.
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005236///
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005237/// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
5238/// conversion.
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005239///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +00005240/// \param From The expression we're converting from.
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005241///
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005242/// \param Converter Used to control and diagnose the conversion process.
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005243///
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005244/// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
5245/// successful.
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005246ExprResult Sema::PerformContextualImplicitConversion(
5247 SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) {
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005248 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
5249 if (From->isTypeDependent())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005250 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005251
Eli Friedmanceccab92012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005252 // Process placeholders immediately.
5253 if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) {
5254 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From);
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005255 if (result.isInvalid())
5256 return result;
Eli Friedmanceccab92012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005257 From = result.take();
5258 }
5259
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005260 // If the expression already has a matching type, we're golden.
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005261 QualType T = From->getType();
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005262 if (Converter.match(T))
Eli Friedmanceccab92012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005263 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005264
5265 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
5266
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005267 // We can only perform contextual implicit conversions on objects of class
5268 // type.
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005269 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005270 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005271 if (!Converter.Suppress)
5272 Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005273 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005274 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005275
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005276 // We must have a complete class type.
Douglas Gregorf502d8e2012-05-04 16:48:41 +00005277 struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser {
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005278 ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter;
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005279 Expr *From;
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005280
5281 TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, Expr *From)
5282 : TypeDiagnoser(Converter.Suppress), Converter(Converter), From(From) {}
5283
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005284 virtual void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005285 Converter.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005286 }
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005287 } IncompleteDiagnoser(Converter, From);
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005288
5289 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005290 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005291
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005292 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005293 UnresolvedSet<4>
5294 ViableConversions; // These are *potentially* viable in C++1y.
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005295 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00005296 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005297 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator> Conversions =
5298 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005299
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005300 bool HadMultipleCandidates =
5301 (std::distance(Conversions.first, Conversions.second) > 1);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005302
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005303 // To check that there is only one target type, in C++1y:
5304 QualType ToType;
5305 bool HasUniqueTargetType = true;
5306
5307 // Collect explicit or viable (potentially in C++1y) conversions.
5308 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator I = Conversions.first,
5309 E = Conversions.second;
5310 I != E; ++I) {
5311 NamedDecl *D = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
5312 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion;
5313 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
5314 if (ConvTemplate) {
5315 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y)
5316 Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
5317 else
5318 continue; // C++11 does not consider conversion operator templates(?).
5319 } else
5320 Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
5321
5322 assert((!ConvTemplate || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y) &&
5323 "Conversion operator templates are considered potentially "
5324 "viable in C++1y");
5325
5326 QualType CurToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5327 if (Converter.match(CurToType) || ConvTemplate) {
5328
5329 if (Conversion->isExplicit()) {
5330 // FIXME: For C++1y, do we need this restriction?
5331 // cf. diagnoseNoViableConversion()
5332 if (!ConvTemplate)
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005333 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005334 } else {
5335 if (!ConvTemplate && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y) {
5336 if (ToType.isNull())
5337 ToType = CurToType.getUnqualifiedType();
5338 else if (HasUniqueTargetType &&
5339 (CurToType.getUnqualifiedType() != ToType))
5340 HasUniqueTargetType = false;
5341 }
5342 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005343 }
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005344 }
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005345 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005346
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005347 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y) {
5348 // C++1y [conv]p6:
5349 // ... An expression e of class type E appearing in such a context
5350 // is said to be contextually implicitly converted to a specified
5351 // type T and is well-formed if and only if e can be implicitly
5352 // converted to a type T that is determined as follows: E is searched
Larisse Voufo7acc5a62013-06-10 08:25:58 +00005353 // for conversion functions whose return type is cv T or reference to
5354 // cv T such that T is allowed by the context. There shall be
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005355 // exactly one such T.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005356
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005357 // If no unique T is found:
5358 if (ToType.isNull()) {
5359 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5360 HadMultipleCandidates,
5361 ExplicitConversions))
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005362 return ExprError();
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005363 return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005364 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005365
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005366 // If more than one unique Ts are found:
5367 if (!HasUniqueTargetType)
5368 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5369 ViableConversions);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005370
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005371 // If one unique T is found:
5372 // First, build a candidate set from the previously recorded
5373 // potentially viable conversions.
5374 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc);
5375 collectViableConversionCandidates(*this, From, ToType, ViableConversions,
5376 CandidateSet);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005377
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005378 // Then, perform overload resolution over the candidate set.
5379 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
5380 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Loc, Best)) {
5381 case OR_Success: {
5382 // Apply this conversion.
5383 DeclAccessPair Found =
5384 DeclAccessPair::make(Best->Function, Best->FoundDecl.getAccess());
5385 if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5386 HadMultipleCandidates, Found))
5387 return ExprError();
5388 break;
5389 }
5390 case OR_Ambiguous:
5391 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5392 ViableConversions);
5393 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
5394 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5395 HadMultipleCandidates,
5396 ExplicitConversions))
5397 return ExprError();
5398 // fall through 'OR_Deleted' case.
5399 case OR_Deleted:
5400 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
5401 break;
5402 }
5403 } else {
5404 switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
5405 case 0: {
5406 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5407 HadMultipleCandidates,
5408 ExplicitConversions))
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005409 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005410
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005411 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
5412 break;
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005413 }
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005414 case 1: {
5415 // Apply this conversion.
5416 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
5417 if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5418 HadMultipleCandidates, Found))
5419 return ExprError();
5420 break;
5421 }
5422 default:
5423 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5424 ViableConversions);
5425 }
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005426 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005427
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005428 return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005429}
5430
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005431/// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00005432/// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If
5433/// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
5434/// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005435///
James Dennett699c9042012-06-15 07:13:21 +00005436/// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005437/// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
5438/// code completion.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005439void
5440Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005441 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005442 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00005443 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redle2b68332009-04-12 17:16:29 +00005444 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00005445 bool PartialOverloading,
5446 bool AllowExplicit) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005447 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005448 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005449 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005450 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
NAKAMURA Takumi00995302011-01-27 07:09:49 +00005451 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005452
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005453 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005454 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
5455 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
5456 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
5457 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
5458 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005459 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
5460 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
5461 // is irrelevant.
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005462 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005463 QualType(), Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005464 Args, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005465 return;
5466 }
5467 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
5468 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005469 }
5470
Douglas Gregorfd476482009-11-13 23:59:09 +00005471 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005472 return;
Douglas Gregor66724ea2009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005473
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005474 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005475 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005476
Douglas Gregor66724ea2009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005477 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)){
5478 // C++ [class.copy]p3:
5479 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
5480 // of a class object to an object of its class type.
5481 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005482 if (Args.size() == 1 &&
Douglas Gregor6493cc52010-11-08 17:16:59 +00005483 Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
Douglas Gregor12116062010-02-21 18:30:38 +00005484 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
5485 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType)))
Douglas Gregor66724ea2009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005486 return;
5487 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005488
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005489 // Add this candidate
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005490 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size());
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005491 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005492 Candidate.Function = Function;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005493 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005494 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005495 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005496 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005497
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005498 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5499
5500 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5501 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5502 // list (8.3.5).
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005503 if ((Args.size() + (PartialOverloading && Args.size())) > NumArgsInProto &&
Douglas Gregor5bd1a112009-09-23 14:56:09 +00005504 !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005505 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005506 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005507 return;
5508 }
5509
5510 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5511 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5512 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5513 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5514 // exactly m parameters.
5515 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005516 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005517 // Not enough arguments.
5518 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005519 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005520 return;
5521 }
5522
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00005523 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005524 if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00005525 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
5526 if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Function)) {
5527 Candidate.Viable = false;
5528 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
5529 return;
5530 }
5531
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005532 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5533 // arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005534 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005535 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5536 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5537 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5538 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5539 // parameter of F.
5540 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005541 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005542 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005543 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005544 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5545 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005546 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00005547 AllowExplicit);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005548 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
5549 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005550 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005551 break;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005552 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005553 } else {
5554 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5555 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5556 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005557 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005558 }
5559 }
5560}
5561
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005562/// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
5563/// the overload canddiate set.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005564void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005565 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005566 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005567 bool SuppressUserConversions,
5568 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005569 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005570 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
5571 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005572 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic())
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005573 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005574 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005575 Args[0]->getType(), Args[0]->Classify(Context),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005576 Args.slice(1), CandidateSet,
5577 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005578 else
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005579 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005580 SuppressUserConversions);
5581 } else {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005582 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005583 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5584 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic())
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005585 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005586 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005587 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005588 Args[0]->getType(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005589 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1),
5590 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005591 else
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005592 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005593 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005594 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005595 }
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005596 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005597}
5598
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005599/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
5600/// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005601void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005602 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005603 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Rafael Espindola548107e2013-04-29 19:29:25 +00005604 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005605 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005606 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005607 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005608 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005609
5610 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
5611 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005612
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005613 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
5614 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5615 "Expected a member function template");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005616 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
5617 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005618 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Rafael Espindola548107e2013-04-29 19:29:25 +00005619 Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005620 SuppressUserConversions);
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005621 } else {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005622 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005623 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Rafael Espindola548107e2013-04-29 19:29:25 +00005624 Args,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005625 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005626 }
5627}
5628
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005629/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
5630/// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
5631/// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
5632/// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
5633/// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
5634/// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005635/// operators.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005636void
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005637Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall86820f52010-01-26 01:37:31 +00005638 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005639 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005640 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005641 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005642 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005643 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005644 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005645 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005646 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
5647 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005648
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005649 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
5650 return;
5651
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005652 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005653 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005654
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005655 // Add this candidate
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005656 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005657 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005658 Candidate.Function = Method;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005659 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005660 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005661 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005662
5663 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5664
5665 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5666 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5667 // list (8.3.5).
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005668 if (Args.size() > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005669 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005670 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005671 return;
5672 }
5673
5674 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5675 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5676 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5677 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5678 // exactly m parameters.
5679 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005680 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005681 // Not enough arguments.
5682 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005683 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005684 return;
5685 }
5686
5687 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005688
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005689 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005690 // The implicit object argument is ignored.
5691 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
5692 else {
5693 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
5694 // parameter.
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005695 Candidate.Conversions[0]
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005696 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5697 Method, ActingContext);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005698 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005699 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005700 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005701 return;
5702 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005703 }
5704
5705 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5706 // arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005707 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005708 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5709 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5710 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5711 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5712 // parameter of F.
5713 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005714 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005715 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005716 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005717 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5718 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005719 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005720 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005721 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005722 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005723 break;
5724 }
5725 } else {
5726 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5727 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5728 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005729 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005730 }
5731 }
5732}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005733
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005734/// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
5735/// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
5736/// function template specialization.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005737void
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005738Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005739 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005740 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00005741 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005742 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005743 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005744 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005745 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005746 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005747 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
5748 return;
5749
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005750 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005751 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005752 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005753 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005754 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
5755 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
5756 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
5757 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
5758 // functions.
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00005759 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005760 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5761 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005762 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
5763 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005764 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005765 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
5766 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
5767 Candidate.Viable = false;
5768 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
5769 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5770 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005771 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005772 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005773 Info);
5774 return;
5775 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005776
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005777 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
5778 // deduction as a candidate.
5779 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005780 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005781 "Specialization is not a member function?");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005782 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005783 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args,
5784 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005785}
5786
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005787/// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
5788/// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
5789/// an appropriate function template specialization.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005790void
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005791Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005792 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00005793 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005794 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005795 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005796 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005797 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
5798 return;
5799
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005800 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005801 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005802 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005803 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005804 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
5805 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
5806 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
5807 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
5808 // functions.
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00005809 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005810 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5811 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005812 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
5813 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005814 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005815 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00005816 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
5817 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005818 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00005819 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5820 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005821 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005822 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005823 Info);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005824 return;
5825 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005826
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005827 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
5828 // deduction as a candidate.
5829 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005830 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005831 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005832}
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005833
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005834/// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005835/// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005836/// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005837/// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005838/// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
5839/// conversion function produces).
5840void
5841Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005842 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005843 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005844 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5845 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005846 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
5847 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00005848 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005849 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
5850 return;
5851
Richard Smith60e141e2013-05-04 07:00:32 +00005852 // If the conversion function has an undeduced return type, trigger its
5853 // deduction now.
5854 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y && ConvType->isUndeducedType()) {
5855 if (DeduceReturnType(Conversion, From->getExprLoc()))
5856 return;
5857 ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5858 }
5859
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005860 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005861 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005862
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005863 // Add this candidate
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005864 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005865 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005866 Candidate.Function = Conversion;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005867 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005868 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005869 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00005870 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00005871 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005872 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005873 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005874
Douglas Gregorbca39322010-08-19 15:37:02 +00005875 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005876 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
5877 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
Douglas Gregorbca39322010-08-19 15:37:02 +00005878 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005879 //
5880 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
5881 // object parameter.
5882 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
5883 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
5884 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
5885 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
5886 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005887
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005888 Candidate.Conversions[0]
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005889 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(),
5890 From->Classify(Context),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005891 Conversion, ConversionContext);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005892
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005893 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005894 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005895 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005896 return;
5897 }
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005898
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005899 // We won't go through a user-define type conversion function to convert a
Fariborz Jahanian3759a032009-10-19 19:18:20 +00005900 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
5901 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
5902 QualType FromCanon
5903 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
5904 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
5905 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
5906 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005907 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
Fariborz Jahanian3759a032009-10-19 19:18:20 +00005908 return;
5909 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005910
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005911 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
5912 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
5913 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
5914 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
5915 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
5916 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
5917 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
5918 // well-formed.
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +00005919 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005920 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart());
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00005921 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
5922 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005923 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00005924 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005925
Richard Smith87c1f1f2011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005926 QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType();
5927 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ConversionType, 0)) {
Douglas Gregor7d14d382010-11-13 19:36:57 +00005928 Candidate.Viable = false;
5929 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
5930 return;
5931 }
5932
Richard Smith87c1f1f2011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005933 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType);
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005934
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005935 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00005936 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
5937 // allocator).
Richard Smith87c1f1f2011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005938 QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Dmitri Gribenko62ed8892013-05-05 20:40:26 +00005939 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, None, CallResultType, VK,
Douglas Gregor0a0d1ac2009-11-17 21:16:22 +00005940 From->getLocStart());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005941 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005942 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
Anders Carlssond28b4282009-08-27 17:18:13 +00005943 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005944 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5945 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005946
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005947 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005948 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5949 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005950
Douglas Gregorc520c842010-04-12 23:42:09 +00005951 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
5952 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005953 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregorc520c842010-04-12 23:42:09 +00005954 // shall have exact match rank.
5955 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
5956 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
5957 Candidate.Viable = false;
5958 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
5959 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005960
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00005961 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
5962 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
5963 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
5964 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
5965 // program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005966 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00005967 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
5968 Candidate.Viable = false;
5969 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
5970 }
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005971 break;
5972
5973 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5974 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005975 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005976 break;
5977
5978 default:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00005979 llvm_unreachable(
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005980 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
5981 }
5982}
5983
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005984/// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization
5985/// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
5986/// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
5987/// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
5988/// [temp.deduct.conv]).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005989void
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005990Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005991 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005992 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005993 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5994 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
5995 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5996 "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
5997
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005998 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
5999 return;
6000
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00006001 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006002 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = 0;
6003 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006004 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006005 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00006006 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00006007 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6008 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
6009 Candidate.Viable = false;
6010 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
6011 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6012 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006013 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006014 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00006015 Info);
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006016 return;
6017 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006018
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006019 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
6020 // template argument deduction as a candidate.
6021 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006022 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
John McCall86820f52010-01-26 01:37:31 +00006023 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006024}
6025
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006026/// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
6027/// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
6028/// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
6029/// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
6030/// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
6031void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006032 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00006033 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00006034 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006035 Expr *Object,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00006036 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006037 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00006038 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
6039 return;
6040
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006041 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00006042 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006043
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00006044 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006045 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006046 Candidate.Function = 0;
6047 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
6048 Candidate.Viable = true;
6049 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006050 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00006051 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006052
6053 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
6054 // object parameter.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006055 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006056 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, Object->getType(),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006057 Object->Classify(Context),
6058 Conversion, ActingContext);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006059 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006060 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006061 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006062 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006063 return;
6064 }
6065
6066 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
6067 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
6068 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006069 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006070 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian966256a2009-11-06 00:23:08 +00006071 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00006072 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006073 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00006074 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006075 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006076 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
6077 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
6078
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006079 // Find the
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006080 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
6081
6082 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
6083 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
6084 // list (8.3.5).
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00006085 if (Args.size() > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006086 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006087 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006088 return;
6089 }
6090
6091 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
6092 // we have enough arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00006093 if (Args.size() < NumArgsInProto) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006094 // Not enough arguments.
6095 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006096 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006097 return;
6098 }
6099
6100 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6101 // arguments.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006102 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006103 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
6104 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
6105 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
6106 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
6107 // parameter of F.
6108 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006109 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00006110 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Anders Carlssond28b4282009-08-27 17:18:13 +00006111 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006112 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
6113 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006114 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006115 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006116 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006117 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006118 break;
6119 }
6120 } else {
6121 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
6122 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
6123 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006124 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006125 }
6126 }
6127}
6128
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006129/// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
6130/// member functions.
6131///
6132/// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
6133/// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
6134/// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
6135/// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
6136/// [over.match.oper]).
6137void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
6138 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006139 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006140 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
6141 SourceRange OpRange) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006142 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
6143
6144 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6145 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
6146 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
6147 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
6148 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
6149 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member
6150 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
6151 // constructed as follows:
6152 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006153
Richard Smithe410be92013-04-20 12:41:22 +00006154 // -- If T1 is a complete class type or a class currently being
6155 // defined, the set of member candidates is the result of the
6156 // qualified lookup of T1::operator@ (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise,
6157 // the set of member candidates is empty.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006158 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Richard Smithe410be92013-04-20 12:41:22 +00006159 // Complete the type if it can be completed.
6160 RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, 0);
6161 // If the type is neither complete nor being defined, bail out now.
6162 if (!T1Rec->getDecl()->getDefinition())
Douglas Gregor8a5ae242009-08-27 23:35:55 +00006163 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006164
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +00006165 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
6166 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
6167 Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
6168
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006169 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
Douglas Gregor8a5ae242009-08-27 23:35:55 +00006170 OperEnd = Operators.end();
6171 Oper != OperEnd;
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00006172 ++Oper)
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006173 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
Rafael Espindola548107e2013-04-29 19:29:25 +00006174 Args[0]->Classify(Context),
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006175 Args.slice(1),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006176 CandidateSet,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00006177 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006178 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006179}
6180
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006181/// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
6182/// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
6183/// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006184/// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
6185/// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006186/// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
6187/// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
6188/// converted to bool.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006189void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys,
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006190 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006191 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006192 bool IsAssignmentOperator,
6193 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006194 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00006195 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006196
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006197 // Add this candidate
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006198 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size());
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006199 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_none);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006200 Candidate.Function = 0;
Douglas Gregorc9467cf2008-12-12 02:00:36 +00006201 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006202 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006203 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy;
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006204 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx)
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006205 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx];
6206
6207 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6208 // arguments.
6209 Candidate.Viable = true;
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006210 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
6211 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006212 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
6213 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
6214 // left operand are restricted as follows:
6215 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
6216 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
6217 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006218 // parameter of a built-in candidate.
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006219 //
6220 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
6221 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
6222 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
6223 // is not of the same type.
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006224 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006225 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006226 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006227 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
6228 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006229 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006230 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00006231 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
Anders Carlssond28b4282009-08-27 17:18:13 +00006232 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006233 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
6234 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006235 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006236 }
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006237 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006238 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006239 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006240 break;
6241 }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006242 }
6243}
6244
6245/// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
6246/// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
6247/// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
6248/// enumeration types.
6249class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet {
6250 /// TypeSet - A set of types.
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006251 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006252
6253 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
6254 /// built-in candidates.
6255 TypeSet PointerTypes;
6256
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006257 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
6258 /// used in the built-in candidates.
6259 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
6260
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006261 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
6262 /// used in the built-in candidates.
6263 TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
6264
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006265 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006266 /// candidates.
6267 TypeSet VectorTypes;
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006268
6269 /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
6270 bool HasNonRecordTypes;
6271
6272 /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
6273 /// were present in the candidate set.
6274 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
6275
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006276 /// \brief A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the
6277 /// candidate set.
6278 bool HasNullPtrType;
6279
Douglas Gregor5842ba92009-08-24 15:23:48 +00006280 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
6281 /// candidate type set.
6282 Sema &SemaRef;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006283
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006284 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
6285 ASTContext &Context;
6286
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006287 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
6288 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006289 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006290
6291public:
6292 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006293 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006294
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006295 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006296 : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
6297 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006298 HasNullPtrType(false),
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006299 SemaRef(SemaRef),
6300 Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006301
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006302 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006303 SourceLocation Loc,
6304 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006305 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6306 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006307
6308 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
6309 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
6310
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006311 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006312 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
6313
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006314 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
6315 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
6316
6317 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
6318 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
6319
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006320 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
6321 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
6322
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006323 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006324 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006325
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006326 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
6327 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006328
6329 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
6330 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006331 bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006332};
6333
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006334/// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006335/// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
6336/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
6337/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
6338/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
6339/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
6340/// false otherwise.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006341///
6342/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006343bool
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006344BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
6345 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006346
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006347 // Insert this type.
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006348 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006349 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006350
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006351 QualType PointeeTy;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006352 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006353 bool buildObjCPtr = false;
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006354 if (!PointerTy) {
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006355 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6356 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
6357 buildObjCPtr = true;
6358 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006359 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006360 }
6361
Sebastian Redla9efada2009-11-18 20:39:26 +00006362 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6363 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6364 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6365 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6366 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6367 return true;
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006368
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006369 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006370 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
6371 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006372
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006373 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
6374 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6375 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006376 // Skip over volatile if no volatile found anywhere in the types.
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006377 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006378
6379 // Skip over restrict if no restrict found anywhere in the types, or if
6380 // the type cannot be restrict-qualified.
6381 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) &&
6382 (!hasRestrict ||
6383 (!(PointeeTy->isAnyPointerType() || PointeeTy->isReferenceType()))))
6384 continue;
6385
6386 // Build qualified pointee type.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006387 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006388
6389 // Build qualified pointer type.
6390 QualType QPointerTy;
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006391 if (!buildObjCPtr)
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006392 QPointerTy = Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy);
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006393 else
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006394 QPointerTy = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy);
6395
6396 // Insert qualified pointer type.
6397 PointerTypes.insert(QPointerTy);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006398 }
6399
6400 return true;
6401}
6402
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006403/// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
6404/// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
6405/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
6406/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
6407/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
6408/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
6409/// false otherwise.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006410///
6411/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006412bool
6413BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
6414 QualType Ty) {
6415 // Insert this type.
6416 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
6417 return false;
6418
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006419 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
6420 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006421
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006422 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redla9efada2009-11-18 20:39:26 +00006423 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6424 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6425 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6426 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6427 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6428 return true;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006429 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
6430
6431 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
6432 // qualifiers.
6433 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
6434 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6435 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006436
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006437 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006438 MemberPointerTypes.insert(
6439 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006440 }
6441
6442 return true;
6443}
6444
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006445/// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
6446/// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006447/// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
6448/// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006449/// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
6450/// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
6451/// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
6452/// type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006453void
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006454BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006455 SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006456 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006457 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6458 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006459 // Only deal with canonical types.
6460 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
6461
6462 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
6463 // expression for the purposes of conversions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006464 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006465 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
6466
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00006467 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
6468 if (Ty->isArrayType())
6469 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
6470
6471 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00006472 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006473
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006474 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
6475 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
6476 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
6477
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006478 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
6479 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
6480 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
6481
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006482 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
6483 PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
6484 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006485 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
6486 // of types.
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006487 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006488 return;
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006489 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
6490 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
6491 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
6492 return;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006493 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006494 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006495 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006496 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006497 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
6498 // extension.
6499 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006500 VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006501 } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) {
6502 HasNullPtrType = true;
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006503 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
6504 // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
6505 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0))
6506 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006507
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006508 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00006509 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
6510 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
6511 Conversions = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
6512 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
6513 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006514 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6515 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6516 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006517
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006518 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
6519 // about which builtin types we can convert to.
6520 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
6521 continue;
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006522
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006523 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
6524 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
6525 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
6526 VisibleQuals);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006527 }
6528 }
6529 }
6530}
6531
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006532/// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
6533/// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
6534/// given type to the candidate set.
6535static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
6536 QualType T,
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006537 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006538 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
6539 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006540
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006541 // T& operator=(T&, T)
6542 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
6543 ParamTypes[1] = T;
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006544 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006545 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006546
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006547 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
6548 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006549 ParamTypes[0]
6550 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006551 ParamTypes[1] = T;
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006552 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006553 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006554 }
6555}
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006556
Sebastian Redl9994a342009-10-25 17:03:50 +00006557/// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
6558/// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006559static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
6560 Qualifiers VRQuals;
6561 const RecordType *TyRec;
6562 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
6563 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
Douglas Gregorb86cf0c2010-04-25 00:55:24 +00006564 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006565 else
6566 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
6567 if (!TyRec) {
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006568 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006569 VRQuals.addVolatile();
6570 VRQuals.addRestrict();
6571 return VRQuals;
6572 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006573
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006574 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
John McCall86ff3082010-02-04 22:26:26 +00006575 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
6576 return VRQuals;
6577
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00006578 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
6579 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
6580 Conversions = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006581
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00006582 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
6583 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall32daa422010-03-31 01:36:47 +00006584 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6585 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6586 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
6587 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006588 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
6589 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
6590 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6591 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
6592 // as see them.
6593 bool done = false;
6594 while (!done) {
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006595 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
6596 VRQuals.addRestrict();
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006597 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6598 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006599 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006600 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
6601 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
6602 else
6603 done = true;
6604 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
6605 VRQuals.addVolatile();
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006606 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
6607 return VRQuals;
6608 }
6609 }
6610 }
6611 return VRQuals;
6612}
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006613
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006614namespace {
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006615
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006616/// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
6617/// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
6618/// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
6619/// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
6620class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006621 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
6622 Sema &S;
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006623 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args;
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006624 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006625 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006626 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006627 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006628
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006629 // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types
6630 // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below.
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006631 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
6632 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006633 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3;
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006634 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 20;
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006635 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006636 LastPromotedIntegralType = 11;
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006637 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006638 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 11;
6639 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 20;
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006640
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006641 /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index.
6642 CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) {
6643 assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes);
6644 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const
6645 ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = {
6646 // Start of promoted types.
6647 &ASTContext::FloatTy,
6648 &ASTContext::DoubleTy,
6649 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy,
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006650
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006651 // Start of integral types.
6652 &ASTContext::IntTy,
6653 &ASTContext::LongTy,
6654 &ASTContext::LongLongTy,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006655 &ASTContext::Int128Ty,
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006656 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy,
6657 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy,
6658 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006659 &ASTContext::UnsignedInt128Ty,
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006660 // End of promoted types.
6661
6662 &ASTContext::BoolTy,
6663 &ASTContext::CharTy,
6664 &ASTContext::WCharTy,
6665 &ASTContext::Char16Ty,
6666 &ASTContext::Char32Ty,
6667 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy,
6668 &ASTContext::ShortTy,
6669 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy,
6670 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy,
6671 // End of integral types.
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006672 // FIXME: What about complex? What about half?
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006673 };
6674 return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index];
6675 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006676
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006677 /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic
6678 /// converions for the given arithmetic types.
6679 CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) {
6680 // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions.
6681 // The rules are basically:
6682 // - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point
6683 // - if same signedness, use the higher rank
6684 // - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank
6685 // - use the larger type
6686 // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are
6687 // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results
6688 // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank.
6689 // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's
6690 // better not to make any assumptions).
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006691 // We assume that int128 has a higher rank than long long on all platforms.
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006692 enum PromotedType {
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006693 Dep=-1,
6694 Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006695 };
Nuno Lopes79e244f2012-04-21 14:45:25 +00006696 static const PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType]
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006697 [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = {
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006698/* Flt*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt },
6699/* Dbl*/ { Dbl, Dbl, LDbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl },
6700/*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl },
6701/* SI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128 },
6702/* SL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SL, SL, SLL, S128, Dep, UL, ULL, U128 },
6703/* SLL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SLL, SLL, SLL, S128, Dep, Dep, ULL, U128 },
6704/*S128*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, U128 },
6705/* UI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UI, Dep, Dep, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128 },
6706/* UL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UL, UL, Dep, S128, UL, UL, ULL, U128 },
6707/* ULL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, ULL, ULL, ULL, S128, ULL, ULL, ULL, U128 },
6708/*U128*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128 },
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006709 };
6710
6711 assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
6712 assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
6713 int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R];
6714
6715 // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer.
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006716 if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx);
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006717
6718 // Slow path: we need to compare widths.
6719 // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank.
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006720 CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L),
6721 RT = getArithmeticType(R);
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006722 unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT),
6723 RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT);
6724
6725 // If they're different widths, use the signed type.
6726 if (LW > RW) return LT;
6727 else if (LW < RW) return RT;
6728
6729 // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank.
6730 if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy;
6731 assert(L == SLL || R == SLL);
6732 return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
6733 }
6734
Chandler Carruth3c69dc42010-12-12 09:22:45 +00006735 /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
6736 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006737 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006738 bool HasVolatile,
6739 bool HasRestrict) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006740 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
6741 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
6742 S.Context.IntTy
6743 };
6744
6745 // Non-volatile version.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006746 if (Args.size() == 1)
6747 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006748 else
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006749 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006750
6751 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
6752 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
6753 if (HasVolatile) {
6754 ParamTypes[0] =
6755 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
6756 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006757 if (Args.size() == 1)
6758 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006759 else
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006760 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006761 }
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006762
6763 // Add restrict version only if there are conversions to a restrict type
6764 // and our candidate type is a non-restrict-qualified pointer.
6765 if (HasRestrict && CandidateTy->isAnyPointerType() &&
6766 !CandidateTy.isRestrictQualified()) {
6767 ParamTypes[0]
6768 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
6769 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, Qualifiers::Restrict));
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006770 if (Args.size() == 1)
6771 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006772 else
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006773 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006774
6775 if (HasVolatile) {
6776 ParamTypes[0]
6777 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
6778 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy,
6779 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
6780 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006781 if (Args.size() == 1)
6782 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006783 else
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006784 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006785 }
6786 }
6787
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006788 }
6789
6790public:
6791 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006792 Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006793 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006794 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006795 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006796 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006797 : S(S), Args(Args),
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006798 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006799 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
6800 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006801 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
6802 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
6803 // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds.
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006804 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006805 "Invalid first promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006806 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1)
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006807 == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006808 "Invalid last promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006809 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType)
6810 == S.Context.FloatTy &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006811 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type");
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006812 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1)
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006813 == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006814 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type");
6815 }
6816
6817 // C++ [over.built]p3:
6818 //
6819 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ
6820 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator
6821 // functions of the form
6822 //
6823 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&);
6824 // T operator++(VQ T&, int);
6825 //
6826 // C++ [over.built]p4:
6827 //
6828 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
6829 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
6830 // candidate operator functions of the form
6831 //
6832 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&);
6833 // T operator--(VQ T&, int);
6834 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006835 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6836 return;
6837
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006838 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1);
6839 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
6840 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006841 getArithmeticType(Arith),
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006842 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(),
6843 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict());
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006844 }
6845 }
6846
6847 // C++ [over.built]p5:
6848 //
6849 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
6850 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
6851 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6852 //
6853 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&);
6854 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&);
6855 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int);
6856 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int);
6857 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
6858 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6859 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6860 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6861 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6862 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006863 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006864 continue;
6865
6866 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006867 (!(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
6868 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()),
6869 (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
6870 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006871 }
6872 }
6873
6874 // C++ [over.built]p6:
6875 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
6876 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6877 //
6878 // T& operator*(T*);
6879 //
6880 // C++ [over.built]p7:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006881 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006882 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006883 // T& operator*(T*);
6884 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
6885 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6886 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6887 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6888 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6889 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
6890 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006891 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
6892 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006893
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006894 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
6895 if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
6896 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006897
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006898 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy),
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006899 &ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006900 }
6901 }
6902
6903 // C++ [over.built]p9:
6904 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
6905 // operator functions of the form
6906 //
6907 // T operator+(T);
6908 // T operator-(T);
6909 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006910 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6911 return;
6912
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006913 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
6914 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006915 QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith);
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006916 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006917 }
6918
6919 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
6920 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6921 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6922 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6923 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
6924 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006925 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006926 }
6927 }
6928
6929 // C++ [over.built]p8:
6930 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
6931 // the form
6932 //
6933 // T* operator+(T*);
6934 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
6935 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6936 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6937 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6938 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6939 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006940 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006941 }
6942 }
6943
6944 // C++ [over.built]p10:
6945 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
6946 // operator functions of the form
6947 //
6948 // T operator~(T);
6949 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006950 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6951 return;
6952
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006953 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
6954 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006955 QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int);
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006956 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006957 }
6958
6959 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
6960 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6961 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6962 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6963 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
6964 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006965 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006966 }
6967 }
6968
6969 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
6970 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator
6971 // functions of the form
6972 //
6973 // bool operator==(T,T);
6974 // bool operator!=(T,T);
6975 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() {
6976 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6977 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6978
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006979 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006980 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6981 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
6982 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
6983 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
6984 ++MemPtr) {
6985 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
6986 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
6987 continue;
6988
6989 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006990 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006991 }
6992 }
6993 }
6994
6995 // C++ [over.built]p15:
6996 //
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006997 // For every T, where T is an enumeration type, a pointer type, or
6998 // std::nullptr_t, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006999 //
7000 // bool operator<(T, T);
7001 // bool operator>(T, T);
7002 // bool operator<=(T, T);
7003 // bool operator>=(T, T);
7004 // bool operator==(T, T);
7005 // bool operator!=(T, T);
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007006 void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
Eli Friedman97c67392012-09-18 21:52:24 +00007007 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7008 // [...]the built-in candidates include all of the candidate operator
7009 // functions defined in 13.6 that, compared to the given operator, [...]
7010 // do not have the same parameter-type-list as any non-template non-member
7011 // candidate.
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007012 //
Eli Friedman97c67392012-09-18 21:52:24 +00007013 // Note that in practice, this only affects enumeration types because there
7014 // aren't any built-in candidates of record type, and a user-defined operator
7015 // must have an operand of record or enumeration type. Also, the only other
7016 // overloaded operator with enumeration arguments, operator=,
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007017 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
7018 // where we must suppress candidates like this.
7019 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
7020 UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
7021
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007022 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007023 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() !=
7024 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
7025 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
7026 CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
7027 C != CEnd; ++C) {
7028 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
7029 continue;
7030
Eli Friedman97c67392012-09-18 21:52:24 +00007031 if (C->Function->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization())
7032 continue;
7033
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007034 QualType FirstParamType =
7035 C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
7036 QualType SecondParamType =
7037 C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
7038
7039 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
7040 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
7041 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
7042 continue;
7043
7044 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
7045 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
7046 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
7047 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
7048 }
7049 }
7050 }
7051
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007052 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7053 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7054
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007055 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007056 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7057 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
7058 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
7059 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7060 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
7061 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7062 continue;
7063
7064 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007065 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007066 }
7067 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7068 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7069 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7070 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7071 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
7072
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007073 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
7074 // candidate exists.
7075 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType) ||
7076 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
7077 CanonType)))
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007078 continue;
7079
7080 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007081 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007082 }
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00007083
7084 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) {
7085 CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy);
7086 if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy) &&
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007087 !UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(NullPtrTy,
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00007088 NullPtrTy))) {
7089 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy };
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007090 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args,
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00007091 CandidateSet);
7092 }
7093 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007094 }
7095 }
7096
7097 // C++ [over.built]p13:
7098 //
7099 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
7100 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7101 //
7102 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
7103 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW]
7104 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
7105 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
7106 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW]
7107 //
7108 // C++ [over.built]p14:
7109 //
7110 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
7111 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7112 //
7113 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
7114 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
7115 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7116 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7117
7118 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
7119 QualType AsymetricParamTypes[2] = {
7120 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
7121 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
7122 };
7123 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7124 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
7125 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
7126 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007127 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
7128 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
7129 continue;
7130
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007131 AsymetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
7132 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
7133 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
7134 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007135 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymetricParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007136 }
7137 if (Op == OO_Minus) {
7138 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
7139 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7140 continue;
7141
7142 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
7143 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes,
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007144 Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007145 }
7146 }
7147 }
7148 }
7149
7150 // C++ [over.built]p12:
7151 //
7152 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
7153 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7154 //
7155 // LR operator*(L, R);
7156 // LR operator/(L, R);
7157 // LR operator+(L, R);
7158 // LR operator-(L, R);
7159 // bool operator<(L, R);
7160 // bool operator>(L, R);
7161 // bool operator<=(L, R);
7162 // bool operator>=(L, R);
7163 // bool operator==(L, R);
7164 // bool operator!=(L, R);
7165 //
7166 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7167 // between types L and R.
7168 //
7169 // C++ [over.built]p24:
7170 //
7171 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
7172 // candidate operator functions of the form
7173 //
7174 // LR operator?(bool, L, R);
7175 //
7176 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7177 // between types L and R.
7178 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
7179 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007180 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7181 return;
7182
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007183 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7184 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
7185 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7186 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007187 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
7188 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007189 QualType Result =
7190 isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007191 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007192 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007193 }
7194 }
7195
7196 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
7197 // conditional operator for vector types.
7198 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7199 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7200 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7201 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
7202 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7203 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
7204 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
7205 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
7206 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
7207 QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy;
7208 if (!isComparison) {
7209 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType())
7210 Result = *Vec1;
7211 else
7212 Result = *Vec2;
7213 }
7214
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007215 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007216 }
7217 }
7218 }
7219
7220 // C++ [over.built]p17:
7221 //
7222 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
7223 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7224 //
7225 // LR operator%(L, R);
7226 // LR operator&(L, R);
7227 // LR operator^(L, R);
7228 // LR operator|(L, R);
7229 // L operator<<(L, R);
7230 // L operator>>(L, R);
7231 //
7232 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7233 // between types L and R.
7234 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007235 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7236 return;
7237
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007238 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7239 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
7240 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7241 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007242 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
7243 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007244 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater)
7245 ? LandR[0]
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007246 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007247 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007248 }
7249 }
7250 }
7251
7252 // C++ [over.built]p20:
7253 //
7254 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
7255 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
7256 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7257 //
7258 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T);
7259 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
7260 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7261 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7262
7263 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
7264 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7265 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7266 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7267 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7268 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
7269 continue;
7270
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007271 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007272 }
7273
7274 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7275 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7276 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7277 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7278 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7279 continue;
7280
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007281 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007282 }
7283 }
7284 }
7285
7286 // C++ [over.built]p19:
7287 //
7288 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
7289 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
7290 // of the form
7291 //
7292 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
7293 //
7294 // C++ [over.built]p21:
7295 //
7296 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
7297 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
7298 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7299 //
7300 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
7301 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
7302 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
7303 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7304 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7305
7306 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7307 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7308 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7309 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7310 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
7311 if (isEqualOp)
7312 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007313 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
7314 continue;
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007315
7316 // non-volatile version
7317 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7318 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
7319 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
7320 };
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007321 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007322 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
7323
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007324 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7325 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
7326 if (NeedVolatile) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007327 // volatile version
7328 ParamTypes[0] =
7329 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007330 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007331 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7332 }
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007333
7334 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7335 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
7336 // restrict version
7337 ParamTypes[0]
7338 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007339 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007340 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7341
7342 if (NeedVolatile) {
7343 // volatile restrict version
7344 ParamTypes[0]
7345 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7346 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
7347 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7348 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007349 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007350 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7351 }
7352 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007353 }
7354
7355 if (isEqualOp) {
7356 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7357 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
7358 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
7359 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7360 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
7361 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7362 continue;
7363
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007364 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7365 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
7366 *Ptr,
7367 };
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007368
7369 // non-volatile version
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007370 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007371 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7372
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007373 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7374 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
7375 if (NeedVolatile) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007376 // volatile version
7377 ParamTypes[0] =
7378 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007379 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7380 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007381 }
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007382
7383 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7384 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
7385 // restrict version
7386 ParamTypes[0]
7387 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007388 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7389 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007390
7391 if (NeedVolatile) {
7392 // volatile restrict version
7393 ParamTypes[0]
7394 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7395 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
7396 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7397 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007398 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7399 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007400 }
7401 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007402 }
7403 }
7404 }
7405
7406 // C++ [over.built]p18:
7407 //
7408 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
7409 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
7410 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
7411 // the form
7412 //
7413 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R);
7414 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R);
7415 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R);
7416 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R);
7417 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R);
7418 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007419 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7420 return;
7421
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007422 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
7423 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7424 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
7425 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007426 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007427
7428 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7429 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007430 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007431 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007432 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7433
7434 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7435 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7436 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007437 S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007438 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007439 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007440 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7441 }
7442 }
7443 }
7444
7445 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
7446 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7447 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7448 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7449 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
7450 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7451 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
7452 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
7453 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
7454 QualType ParamTypes[2];
7455 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
7456 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7457 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007458 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007459 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7460
7461 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7462 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7463 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
7464 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007465 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007466 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7467 }
7468 }
7469 }
7470 }
7471
7472 // C++ [over.built]p22:
7473 //
7474 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
7475 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
7476 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7477 //
7478 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R);
7479 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
7480 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
7481 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R);
7482 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R);
7483 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R);
7484 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007485 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7486 return;
7487
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007488 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
7489 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7490 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
7491 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007492 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007493
7494 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7495 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007496 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007497 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007498 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7499 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007500 ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007501 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
7502 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007503 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007504 }
7505 }
7506 }
7507 }
7508
7509 // C++ [over.operator]p23:
7510 //
7511 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
7512 //
7513 // bool operator!(bool);
7514 // bool operator&&(bool, bool);
7515 // bool operator||(bool, bool);
7516 void addExclaimOverload() {
7517 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007518 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007519 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
7520 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
7521 }
7522 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
7523 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007524 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007525 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
7526 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
7527 }
7528
7529 // C++ [over.built]p13:
7530 //
7531 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
7532 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7533 //
7534 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
7535 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
7536 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
7537 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE]
7538 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
7539 void addSubscriptOverloads() {
7540 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7541 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7542 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7543 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7544 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
7545 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007546 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
7547 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007548
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007549 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
7550
7551 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007552 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007553 }
7554
7555 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7556 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
7557 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
7558 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7559 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
7560 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007561 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
7562 continue;
7563
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007564 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
7565
7566 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007567 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007568 }
7569 }
7570
7571 // C++ [over.built]p11:
7572 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
7573 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
7574 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
7575 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7576 //
7577 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
7578 //
7579 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
7580 void addArrowStarOverloads() {
7581 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7582 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7583 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7584 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7585 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
7586 QualType C1;
7587 QualifierCollector Q1;
7588 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
7589 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
7590 continue;
7591 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
7592 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
7593 // volatile/restrict type.
7594 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
7595 continue;
7596 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
7597 continue;
7598 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7599 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
7600 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
7601 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7602 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
7603 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
7604 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
7605 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2))
7606 break;
7607 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
7608 // build CV12 T&
7609 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
7610 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
7611 T.isVolatileQualified())
7612 continue;
7613 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
7614 T.isRestrictQualified())
7615 continue;
7616 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
7617 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007618 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007619 }
7620 }
7621 }
7622
7623 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
7624 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
7625 // therefore added as binary.
7626 //
7627 // C++ [over.built]p25:
7628 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
7629 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7630 //
7631 // T operator?(bool, T, T);
7632 //
7633 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
7634 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7635 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7636
7637 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
7638 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7639 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
7640 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
7641 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7642 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7643 continue;
7644
7645 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007646 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007647 }
7648
7649 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7650 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7651 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7652 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7653 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7654 continue;
7655
7656 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007657 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007658 }
7659
Richard Smith80ad52f2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00007660 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007661 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7662 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7663 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7664 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7665 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
7666 continue;
7667
7668 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
7669 continue;
7670
7671 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007672 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007673 }
7674 }
7675 }
7676 }
7677};
7678
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007679} // end anonymous namespace
7680
7681/// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
7682/// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
7683/// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
7684/// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
7685/// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
7686void
7687Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
7688 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007689 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007690 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007691 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
7692 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007693 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
7694 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00007695 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
7696 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007697 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx)
Fariborz Jahanian8621d012009-10-19 21:30:45 +00007698 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007699
7700 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
7701 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007702 SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007703 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregorfec56e72010-11-03 17:00:07 +00007704 CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this));
7705 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
7706 OpLoc,
7707 true,
7708 (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
7709 Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
7710 Op == OO_PipePipe),
7711 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007712 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
7713 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
7714 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
7715 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
7716 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
Douglas Gregorfec56e72010-11-03 17:00:07 +00007717 }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007718
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007719 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
7720 // for any of the arguments to the operator.
Douglas Gregor25aaff92011-10-10 14:05:31 +00007721 //
7722 // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have
7723 // 'bool' overloads.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007724 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType &&
Douglas Gregor25aaff92011-10-10 14:05:31 +00007725 !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe))
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007726 return;
7727
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007728 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007729 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007730 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007731 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007732 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
7733
7734 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007735 switch (Op) {
7736 case OO_None:
7737 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007738 llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator");
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007739
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007740 case OO_New:
7741 case OO_Delete:
7742 case OO_Array_New:
7743 case OO_Array_Delete:
7744 case OO_Call:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007745 llvm_unreachable(
7746 "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007747
7748 case OO_Comma:
7749 case OO_Arrow:
7750 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7751 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
7752 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007753 break;
7754
7755 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007756 if (Args.size() == 1)
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007757 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth32fe0d02010-12-12 08:41:34 +00007758 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007759
7760 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007761 if (Args.size() == 1) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007762 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
Chandler Carruthfe622742010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007763 } else {
7764 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
7765 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7766 }
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007767 break;
7768
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007769 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007770 if (Args.size() == 1)
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007771 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
7772 else
7773 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7774 break;
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007775
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007776 case OO_Slash:
7777 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
Chandler Carruthc1409462010-12-12 08:45:02 +00007778 break;
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007779
7780 case OO_PlusPlus:
7781 case OO_MinusMinus:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007782 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
7783 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007784 break;
7785
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00007786 case OO_EqualEqual:
7787 case OO_ExclaimEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007788 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruthdaf55d32010-12-12 08:32:28 +00007789 // Fall through.
Chandler Carruthc1409462010-12-12 08:45:02 +00007790
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007791 case OO_Less:
7792 case OO_Greater:
7793 case OO_LessEqual:
7794 case OO_GreaterEqual:
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007795 OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Chandler Carruthdaf55d32010-12-12 08:32:28 +00007796 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true);
7797 break;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007798
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007799 case OO_Percent:
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007800 case OO_Caret:
7801 case OO_Pipe:
7802 case OO_LessLess:
7803 case OO_GreaterGreater:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007804 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007805 break;
7806
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007807 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007808 if (Args.size() == 1)
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007809 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7810 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
7811 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
7812 break;
7813
7814 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
7815 break;
7816
7817 case OO_Tilde:
7818 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
7819 break;
7820
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007821 case OO_Equal:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007822 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00007823 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007824
7825 case OO_PlusEqual:
7826 case OO_MinusEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007827 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007828 // Fall through.
7829
7830 case OO_StarEqual:
7831 case OO_SlashEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007832 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007833 break;
7834
7835 case OO_PercentEqual:
7836 case OO_LessLessEqual:
7837 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
7838 case OO_AmpEqual:
7839 case OO_CaretEqual:
7840 case OO_PipeEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007841 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007842 break;
7843
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007844 case OO_Exclaim:
7845 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007846 break;
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007847
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007848 case OO_AmpAmp:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007849 case OO_PipePipe:
7850 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007851 break;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007852
7853 case OO_Subscript:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007854 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007855 break;
7856
7857 case OO_ArrowStar:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007858 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007859 break;
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00007860
7861 case OO_Conditional:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007862 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
Chandler Carruthfe622742010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007863 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7864 break;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007865 }
7866}
7867
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007868/// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
7869/// to the set of overloading candidates.
7870///
7871/// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
7872/// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
7873/// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
7874/// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007875void
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007876Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
Richard Smithf5cd5cc2012-02-25 06:24:24 +00007877 bool Operator, SourceLocation Loc,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00007878 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00007879 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007880 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00007881 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007882 ADLResult Fns;
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007883
John McCalla113e722010-01-26 06:04:06 +00007884 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
7885 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
7886 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However,
7887 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
7888 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are
7889 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
7890
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007891 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00007892 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Operator, Loc, Args, Fns);
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007893
Douglas Gregor3fd95ce2009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007894 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
Douglas Gregor3fd95ce2009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007895 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
7896 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
7897 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007898 if (Cand->Function) {
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007899 Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007900 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007901 Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007902 }
Douglas Gregor3fd95ce2009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007903
7904 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
7905 // set.
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007906 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007907 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007908 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007909 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007910 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007911
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00007912 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false,
7913 PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007914 } else
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007915 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007916 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00007917 Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007918 }
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007919}
7920
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007921/// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
7922/// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007923bool
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007924isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
Nick Lewycky7663f392010-11-20 01:29:55 +00007925 const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
7926 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007927 SourceLocation Loc,
7928 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007929 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
7930 // functions.
7931 if (!Cand2.Viable)
7932 return Cand1.Viable;
7933 else if (!Cand1.Viable)
7934 return false;
7935
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007936 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
7937 //
7938 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
7939 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
7940 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
7941 // better nor worse than ICS1(F).
7942 unsigned StartArg = 0;
7943 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
7944 StartArg = 1;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007945
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007946 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007947 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
7948 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007949 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00007950 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.NumConversions;
7951 assert(Cand2.NumConversions == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007952 bool HasBetterConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007953 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007954 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
7955 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007956 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
7957 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
7958 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
7959 HasBetterConversion = true;
7960 break;
7961
7962 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
7963 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
7964 return false;
7965
7966 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
7967 // Do nothing.
7968 break;
7969 }
7970 }
7971
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007972 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007973 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007974 if (HasBetterConversion)
7975 return true;
7976
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007977 // - F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007978 // specialization, or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorccd47132010-06-08 21:03:17 +00007979 if ((!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) &&
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007980 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
7981 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007982
7983 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
7984 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
7985 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007986 // if not that,
Douglas Gregor1f561c12009-08-02 23:46:29 +00007987 if (Cand1.Function && Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007988 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007989 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007990 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
7991 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
7992 Loc,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007993 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
Douglas Gregor5c7bf422011-01-11 17:34:58 +00007994 : TPOC_Call,
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007995 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments))
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007996 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007997 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007998
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007999 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
8000 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
8001 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
8002 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
8003 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
8004 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00008005 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008006 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00008007 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00008008 // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the
8009 // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension
8010 // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function
8011 // pointer or block.
8012 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind FuncResult
8013 = compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function);
8014 if (FuncResult != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
8015 return FuncResult;
8016
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008017 switch (CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
8018 Cand1.FinalConversion,
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00008019 Cand2.FinalConversion)) {
8020 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
8021 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
8022 return true;
8023
8024 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
8025 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
8026 return false;
8027
8028 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
8029 // Do nothing
8030 break;
8031 }
8032 }
8033
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008034 return false;
8035}
8036
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008037/// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008038/// within an overload candidate set.
8039///
James Dennettefce31f2012-06-22 08:10:18 +00008040/// \param Loc The location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008041/// which overload resolution occurs.
8042///
James Dennettefce31f2012-06-22 08:10:18 +00008043/// \param Best If overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
8044/// function, \p Best points to the candidate function found.
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008045///
8046/// \returns The result of overload resolution.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008047OverloadingResult
8048OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Nick Lewycky7663f392010-11-20 01:29:55 +00008049 iterator &Best,
Chandler Carruth25ca4212011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008050 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008051 // Find the best viable function.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008052 Best = end();
8053 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
8054 if (Cand->Viable)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008055 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc,
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00008056 UserDefinedConversion))
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008057 Best = Cand;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008058 }
8059
8060 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008061 if (Best == end())
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008062 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
8063
8064 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
8065 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008066 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008067 if (Cand->Viable &&
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008068 Cand != Best &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008069 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc,
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00008070 UserDefinedConversion)) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008071 Best = end();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008072 return OR_Ambiguous;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008073 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008074 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008075
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008076 // Best is the best viable function.
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008077 if (Best->Function &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidis572bbec2011-06-23 00:41:50 +00008078 (Best->Function->isDeleted() ||
8079 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Best->Function)))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008080 return OR_Deleted;
8081
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008082 return OR_Success;
8083}
8084
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008085namespace {
8086
8087enum OverloadCandidateKind {
8088 oc_function,
8089 oc_method,
8090 oc_constructor,
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008091 oc_function_template,
8092 oc_method_template,
8093 oc_constructor_template,
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008094 oc_implicit_default_constructor,
8095 oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00008096 oc_implicit_move_constructor,
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008097 oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00008098 oc_implicit_move_assignment,
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008099 oc_implicit_inherited_constructor
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008100};
8101
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008102OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
8103 FunctionDecl *Fn,
8104 std::string &Description) {
8105 bool isTemplate = false;
8106
8107 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
8108 isTemplate = true;
8109 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
8110 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
8111 }
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008112
8113 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008114 if (!Ctor->isImplicit())
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008115 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor;
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008116
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008117 if (Ctor->getInheritedConstructor())
8118 return oc_implicit_inherited_constructor;
8119
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00008120 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor())
8121 return oc_implicit_default_constructor;
8122
8123 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor())
8124 return oc_implicit_move_constructor;
8125
8126 assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() &&
8127 "unexpected sort of implicit constructor");
8128 return oc_implicit_copy_constructor;
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008129 }
8130
8131 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
8132 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
8133 // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008134 if (!Meth->isImplicit())
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008135 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method;
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008136
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00008137 if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
8138 return oc_implicit_move_assignment;
8139
Douglas Gregoref7d78b2012-02-10 08:36:38 +00008140 if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator())
8141 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
8142
8143 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion");
8144 return oc_method;
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008145 }
8146
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008147 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function;
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008148}
8149
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008150void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn) {
8151 const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn);
8152 if (!Ctor) return;
8153
8154 Ctor = Ctor->getInheritedConstructor();
8155 if (!Ctor) return;
8156
8157 S.Diag(Ctor->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor);
8158}
8159
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008160} // end anonymous namespace
8161
8162// Notes the location of an overload candidate.
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008163void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn, QualType DestType) {
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008164 std::string FnDesc;
8165 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc);
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008166 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
8167 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc;
8168 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType);
8169 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008170 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Fn);
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008171}
8172
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008173//Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
8174// OverloadedExpr
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008175void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr* OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008176 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
8177
8178 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
8179 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
8180
8181 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
8182 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
8183 I != IEnd; ++I) {
8184 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
8185 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008186 NoteOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), DestType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008187 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
8188 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008189 NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun, DestType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008190 }
8191 }
8192}
8193
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008194/// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the
8195/// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
8196/// target types of the conversion.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008197void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
8198 Sema &S,
8199 SourceLocation CaretLoc,
8200 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
8201 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
8202 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
Matt Beaumont-Gay45a37da2012-11-08 20:50:02 +00008203 // FIXME: The note limiting machinery is borrowed from
8204 // OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates; there's an opportunity for
8205 // refactoring here.
8206 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
8207 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
8208 AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator I, E;
8209 for (I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8210 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
8211 break;
8212 ++CandsShown;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008213 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008214 }
Matt Beaumont-Gay45a37da2012-11-08 20:50:02 +00008215 if (I != E)
8216 S.Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008217}
8218
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008219namespace {
8220
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008221void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) {
8222 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
8223 assert(Conv.isBad());
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008224 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
8225 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8226
8227 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
8228 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the
8229 // conversion-slot index.
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008230 bool isObjectArgument = false;
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008231 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008232 if (I == 0)
8233 isObjectArgument = true;
8234 else
8235 I--;
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008236 }
8237
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008238 std::string FnDesc;
8239 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
8240
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008241 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
8242 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
8243 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008244
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008245 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008246 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008247 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
8248 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
8249 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00008250 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008251
8252 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
8253 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8254 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8255 << ToTy << Name << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008256 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008257 return;
8258 }
8259
John McCall258b2032010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008260 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
8261 // to a qualifier mismatch.
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008262 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
8263 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
8264 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8265 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
8266 else {
8267 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
8268 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8269 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8270 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
8271 }
8272
8273 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
8274 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008275 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
8276 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
8277
8278 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
8279 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
8280 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8281 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8282 << FromTy
8283 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
8284 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008285 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008286 return;
8287 }
8288
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008289 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8b03132011-06-24 00:08:59 +00008290 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership)
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008291 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8292 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8293 << FromTy
8294 << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime()
8295 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8296 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8297 return;
8298 }
8299
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00008300 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) {
8301 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc)
8302 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8303 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8304 << FromTy
8305 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()
8306 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8307 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8308 return;
8309 }
8310
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008311 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
8312 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
8313
8314 if (isObjectArgument) {
8315 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
8316 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8317 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8318 << FromTy << (CVR - 1);
8319 } else {
8320 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
8321 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8322 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8323 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1;
8324 }
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008325 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008326 return;
8327 }
8328
Sebastian Redlfd2a00a2011-09-24 17:48:32 +00008329 // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since
8330 // telling the user that it has type void is not useful.
8331 if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) {
8332 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument)
8333 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8334 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8335 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8336 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8337 return;
8338 }
8339
John McCall258b2032010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008340 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
8341 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
8342 // the failure.
8343 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
8344 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8345 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
8346 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
8347 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
8348 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8349 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8350 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008351 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall258b2032010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008352 return;
8353 }
8354
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008355 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008356 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008357 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8358 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8359 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
8360 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
8361 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
8362 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008363 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008364 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008365 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008366 }
8367 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
8368 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
8369 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
8370 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
8371 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
8372 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
8373 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
8374 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
8375 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008376 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
8377 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Kaelyn Uhrain0d3317e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008378 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
8379 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
8380 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
8381 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) {
8382 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
8383 } else if (ToTy->isLValueReferenceType() && !FromExpr->isLValue() &&
8384 ToTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType() ==
8385 FromTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType()) {
Kaelyn Uhrain0d3317e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008386 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_lvalue)
8387 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8388 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8389 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1;
8390 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8391 return;
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008392 }
Kaelyn Uhrain0d3317e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008393 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008394
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008395 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008396 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008397 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008398 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8399 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008400 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008401 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008402 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008403 return;
8404 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008405
Fariborz Jahanian909bcb32011-07-20 17:14:09 +00008406 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) &&
8407 isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) {
8408 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
8409 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
8410 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
8411 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv)
8412 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8413 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8414 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8415 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8416 return;
8417 }
8418 }
8419
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008420 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
8421 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv);
8422 FDiag << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008423 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008424 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1
8425 << (unsigned) (Cand->Fix.Kind);
8426
8427 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
Benjamin Kramer1136ef02012-01-14 21:05:10 +00008428 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(),
8429 HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI)
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008430 FDiag << *HI;
8431 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag);
8432
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008433 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008434}
8435
8436void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
8437 unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
8438 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
8439
8440 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8441 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8442
8443 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008444
Douglas Gregor439d3c32011-05-05 00:13:13 +00008445 // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we
8446 // have an arity mismatch when it fact it looks like we have the
8447 // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have
8448 // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions.
8449 // Just don't report anything.
8450 if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() &&
8451 Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName)
8452 return;
8453
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008454 // at least / at most / exactly
8455 unsigned mode, modeCount;
8456 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008457 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
8458 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
8459 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008460 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs() ||
Douglas Gregorf5c65ff2011-01-06 22:09:01 +00008461 FnTy->isVariadic() || FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008462 mode = 0; // "at least"
8463 else
8464 mode = 2; // "exactly"
8465 modeCount = MinParams;
8466 } else {
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008467 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
8468 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
8469 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008470 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs())
8471 mode = 1; // "at most"
8472 else
8473 mode = 2; // "exactly"
8474 modeCount = FnTy->getNumArgs();
8475 }
8476
8477 std::string Description;
8478 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description);
8479
Richard Smithf7b80562012-05-11 05:16:41 +00008480 if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName())
8481 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one)
8482 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
8483 << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs;
8484 else
8485 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
8486 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
8487 << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008488 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008489}
8490
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008491/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
8492void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008493 unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008494 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; // pattern
8495
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008496 TemplateParameter Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008497 NamedDecl *ParamD;
8498 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
8499 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
8500 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008501 switch (Cand->DeductionFailure.Result) {
8502 case Sema::TDK_Success:
8503 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
8504
8505 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008506 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
8507 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
8508 << ParamD->getDeclName();
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008509 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008510 return;
8511 }
8512
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008513 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
8514 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
8515 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
8516
8517 QualType Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
8518
8519 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
8520 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00008521 QualifierCollector Qs;
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008522 Qs.strip(Param);
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00008523 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008524 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
8525
8526 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
8527 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
8528 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
8529 // done on dependent types).
8530 QualType Arg = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
8531
8532 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
8533 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008534 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008535 return;
8536 }
8537
8538 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008539 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008540 int which = 0;
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008541 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008542 which = 0;
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008543 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008544 which = 1;
8545 else {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008546 which = 2;
8547 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008548
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008549 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008550 << which << ParamD->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008551 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
8552 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008553 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008554 return;
8555 }
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008556
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008557 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008558 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008559 if (ParamD->getDeclName())
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008560 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008561 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
8562 << ParamD->getDeclName();
8563 else {
8564 int index = 0;
8565 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
8566 index = TTP->getIndex();
8567 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
8568 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
8569 index = NTTP->getIndex();
8570 else
8571 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008572 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008573 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
8574 << (index + 1);
8575 }
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008576 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008577 return;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008578
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008579 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
8580 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
8581 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
8582 return;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008583
8584 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
8585 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008586 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008587 return;
8588
8589 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008590 // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00008591 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008592 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args =
8593 Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) {
8594 TemplateArgString = " ";
8595 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
8596 Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
8597 }
8598
Richard Smith4493c0a2012-05-09 05:17:00 +00008599 // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so.
8600 PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic();
8601 if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() ==
8602 diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) {
8603 // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified
8604 // name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag.
8605 S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if)
8606 << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString;
8607 return;
8608 }
8609
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008610 // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string.
8611 // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s
8612 // formatted message in another diagnostic.
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00008613 SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString;
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008614 SourceRange R;
Richard Smith4493c0a2012-05-09 05:17:00 +00008615 if (PDiag) {
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008616 SFINAEArgString = ": ";
8617 R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first);
8618 PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString);
8619 }
8620
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008621 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008622 << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008623 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008624 return;
8625 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008626
Richard Smith0efa62f2013-01-31 04:03:12 +00008627 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: {
8628 OverloadExpr::FindResult R =
8629 OverloadExpr::find(Cand->DeductionFailure.getExpr());
8630 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
8631 diag::note_ovl_candidate_failed_overload_resolution)
8632 << R.Expression->getName();
8633 return;
8634 }
8635
Richard Trieueef35f82013-04-08 21:11:40 +00008636 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00008637 // FIXME: Provide a source location to indicate what we couldn't match.
Richard Trieueef35f82013-04-08 21:11:40 +00008638 TemplateArgument FirstTA = *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg();
8639 TemplateArgument SecondTA = *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
8640 if (FirstTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template &&
8641 SecondTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template) {
8642 TemplateName FirstTN = FirstTA.getAsTemplate();
8643 TemplateName SecondTN = SecondTA.getAsTemplate();
8644 if (FirstTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template &&
8645 SecondTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template) {
8646 if (FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName() ==
8647 SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName()) {
8648 // FIXME: This fixes a bad diagnostic where both templates are named
8649 // the same. This particular case is a bit difficult since:
8650 // 1) It is passed as a string to the diagnostic printer.
8651 // 2) The diagnostic printer only attempts to find a better
8652 // name for types, not decls.
8653 // Ideally, this should folded into the diagnostic printer.
8654 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
8655 diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch_qualified)
8656 << FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl() << SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl();
8657 return;
8658 }
8659 }
8660 }
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00008661 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch)
Richard Trieueef35f82013-04-08 21:11:40 +00008662 << FirstTA << SecondTA;
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00008663 return;
Richard Trieueef35f82013-04-08 21:11:40 +00008664 }
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008665 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
8666 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00008667 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008668 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008669 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008670 return;
8671 }
8672}
8673
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00008674/// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets.
8675void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8676 FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
8677 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
8678
8679 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller),
8680 CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee);
8681
8682 std::string FnDesc;
8683 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Callee, FnDesc);
8684
8685 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target)
8686 << (unsigned) FnKind << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget;
8687}
8688
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008689/// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've
8690/// already generated a primary error at the call site.
8691///
8692/// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
8693/// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some
8694/// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing
8695/// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still
8696/// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
8697/// overload.
8698///
8699/// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
8700/// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
8701/// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008702void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008703 unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008704 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8705
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008706 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis572bbec2011-06-23 00:41:50 +00008707 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() ||
8708 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Fn))) {
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008709 std::string FnDesc;
8710 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008711
8712 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
Richard Smith5bdaac52012-04-02 20:59:25 +00008713 << FnKind << FnDesc
8714 << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008715 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008716 return;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008717 }
8718
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008719 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
8720 if (Cand->Viable) {
8721 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
8722 return;
8723 }
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008724
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008725 switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
8726 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
8727 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
8728 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008729
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008730 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008731 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008732
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008733 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
8734 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
Douglas Gregorc520c842010-04-12 23:42:09 +00008735 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008736 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008737
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008738 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
8739 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008740 for (unsigned N = Cand->NumConversions; I != N; ++I)
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008741 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
8742 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008743
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008744 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
8745 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle
8746 // those conditions and diagnose them well.
8747 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008748 }
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00008749
8750 case ovl_fail_bad_target:
8751 return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand);
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008752 }
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008753}
8754
8755void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8756 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
8757 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
8758 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
8759 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
8760 bool isLValueReference = false;
8761 bool isRValueReference = false;
8762 bool isPointer = false;
8763 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
8764 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
8765 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
8766 isLValueReference = true;
8767 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
8768 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
8769 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
8770 isRValueReference = true;
8771 }
8772 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8773 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8774 isPointer = true;
8775 }
8776 // Desugar down to a function type.
8777 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
8778 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
8779 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
8780 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
8781 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
8782
8783 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
8784 << FnType;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008785 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->Surrogate);
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008786}
8787
8788void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S,
David Blaikie0bea8632012-10-08 01:11:04 +00008789 StringRef Opc,
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008790 SourceLocation OpLoc,
8791 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008792 assert(Cand->NumConversions <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008793 std::string TypeStr("operator");
8794 TypeStr += Opc;
8795 TypeStr += "(";
8796 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString();
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008797 if (Cand->NumConversions == 1) {
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008798 TypeStr += ")";
8799 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
8800 } else {
8801 TypeStr += ", ";
8802 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString();
8803 TypeStr += ")";
8804 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
8805 }
8806}
8807
8808void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
8809 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008810 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->NumConversions;
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008811 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) {
8812 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx];
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008813 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
8814 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
8815
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008816 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00008817 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008818 }
8819}
8820
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008821SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8822 if (Cand->Function)
8823 return Cand->Function->getLocation();
John McCallf3cf22b2010-01-16 03:50:16 +00008824 if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008825 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
8826 return SourceLocation();
8827}
8828
Benjamin Kramerafc5b152011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008829static unsigned
8830RankDeductionFailure(const OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) {
Chandler Carruth78bf6802011-09-10 00:51:24 +00008831 switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) {
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008832 case Sema::TDK_Success:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008833 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
Benjamin Kramerafc5b152011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008834
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +00008835 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008836 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
8837 return 1;
8838
8839 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
8840 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
8841 return 2;
8842
8843 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
8844 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00008845 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008846 return 3;
8847
8848 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
8849 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
8850 return 4;
8851
8852 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
8853 return 5;
8854
8855 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
8856 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
8857 return 6;
8858 }
Benjamin Kramerafc5b152011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008859 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result");
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008860}
8861
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008862struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
8863 Sema &S;
8864 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008865
8866 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
8867 const OverloadCandidate *R) {
John McCallf3cf22b2010-01-16 03:50:16 +00008868 // Fast-path this check.
8869 if (L == R) return false;
8870
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008871 // Order first by viability.
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008872 if (L->Viable) {
8873 if (!R->Viable) return true;
8874
8875 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
8876 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
8877 // that could exploit it.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008878 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true;
8879 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false;
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008880 } else if (R->Viable)
8881 return false;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008882
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008883 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008884
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008885 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
8886 if (!L->Viable) {
8887 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
8888 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
8889 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
8890 return false;
8891 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
8892 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
8893 return true;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008894
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008895 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
8896 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
8897 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
8898 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
8899 return true;
8900
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008901 // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes,
8902 // comes first.
8903 unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
8904 unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
8905 numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes;
8906 numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes;
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00008907 if (numLFixes != numRFixes) {
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008908 if (numLFixes < numRFixes)
8909 return true;
8910 else
8911 return false;
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00008912 }
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008913
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008914 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
8915 // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008916 assert(L->NumConversions == R->NumConversions);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008917
8918 int leftBetter = 0;
John McCall3a813372010-02-25 10:46:05 +00008919 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008920 for (unsigned E = L->NumConversions; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008921 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
8922 L->Conversions[I],
8923 R->Conversions[I])) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008924 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
8925 leftBetter++;
8926 break;
8927
8928 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
8929 leftBetter--;
8930 break;
8931
8932 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
8933 break;
8934 }
8935 }
8936 if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
8937 if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
8938
8939 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
8940 return false;
8941
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008942 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) {
8943 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
8944 return true;
8945
8946 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
8947 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure)
Eli Friedmance1846e2011-10-14 23:10:30 +00008948 < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
Eli Friedman1c522f72011-10-14 21:52:24 +00008949 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
8950 return false;
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008951
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008952 // TODO: others?
8953 }
8954
8955 // Sort everything else by location.
8956 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
8957 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
8958
8959 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
8960 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
8961 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
8962
8963 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008964 }
8965};
8966
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008967/// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008968/// computes up to the first. Produces the FixIt set if possible.
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008969void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00008970 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008971 assert(!Cand->Viable);
8972
8973 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
8974 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
8975
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008976 // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected.
8977 bool Unfixable = false;
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008978 // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes.
8979 Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization);
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008980
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008981 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion.
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008982 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008983 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->NumConversions;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008984 while (true) {
8985 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
8986 ConvIdx++;
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008987 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad()) {
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008988 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx - 1, S);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008989 break;
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008990 }
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008991 }
8992
8993 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount)
8994 return;
8995
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008996 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
8997 "remaining conversion is initialized?");
8998
Douglas Gregor23ef6c02010-04-16 17:45:54 +00008999 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009000 // operation somehow.
9001 bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009002
9003 const FunctionProtoType* Proto;
9004 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx;
9005
9006 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
9007 QualType ConvType
9008 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
9009 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
9010 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
9011 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9012 ArgIdx--;
9013 } else if (Cand->Function) {
9014 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9015 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
9016 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function))
9017 ArgIdx--;
9018 } else {
9019 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion.
9020 assert(ConvCount <= 3);
9021 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx)
9022 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00009023 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx],
9024 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx],
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009025 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00009026 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true,
9027 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009028 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009029 return;
9030 }
9031
9032 // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
9033 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
9034 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009035 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009036 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00009037 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009038 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00009039 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
9040 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009041 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009042 // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists.
9043 if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00009044 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009045 }
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009046 else
9047 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
9048 }
9049}
9050
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009051} // end anonymous namespace
9052
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00009053/// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints
9054/// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009055/// set.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009056void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S,
9057 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009058 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
David Blaikie0bea8632012-10-08 01:11:04 +00009059 StringRef Opc,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009060 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009061 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would
9062 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00009063 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009064 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
9065 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009066 if (Cand->Viable)
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009067 Cands.push_back(Cand);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009068 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009069 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args);
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009070 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
9071 Cands.push_back(Cand);
9072 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general,
9073 // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009074 }
9075 }
9076
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00009077 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009078 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009079
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00009080 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009081
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00009082 SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
Douglas Gregordc7b6412012-10-23 23:11:23 +00009083 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009084 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009085 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
9086 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
Douglas Gregor621b3932008-11-21 02:54:28 +00009087
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009088 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
9089 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
9090 // candidate list.
Douglas Gregordc7b6412012-10-23 23:11:23 +00009091 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) {
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009092 break;
9093 }
9094 ++CandsShown;
9095
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009096 if (Cand->Function)
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009097 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size());
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009098 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009099 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009100 else {
9101 assert(Cand->Viable &&
9102 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00009103 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
9104 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
9105 // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
9106 //
9107 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
9108 // different ambiguities, though.
9109 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009110 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00009111 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
9112 }
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009113
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00009114 // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009115 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00009116 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00009117 }
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009118
9119 if (I != E)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009120 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00009121}
9122
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009123// [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return]
9124// NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
9125// R (A) --> R(A)
9126// R (*)(A) --> R (A)
9127// R (&)(A) --> R (A)
9128// R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
9129QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
9130 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
9131 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
9132 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
9133 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
9134 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
9135 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
9136 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00009137 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009138 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
9139 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
9140 Ret =
9141 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
9142 return Ret;
9143}
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009144
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009145// A helper class to help with address of function resolution
9146// - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
9147class AddressOfFunctionResolver
9148{
9149 Sema& S;
9150 Expr* SourceExpr;
9151 const QualType& TargetType;
9152 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
9153
9154 bool Complain;
9155 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
9156 ASTContext& Context;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009157
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009158 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
9159 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009160
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009161 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
9162 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
9163 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00009164 SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009165
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009166public:
9167 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr* SourceExpr,
9168 const QualType& TargetType, bool Complain)
9169 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
9170 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
9171 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
9172 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
9173 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
9174 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
9175 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression)
9176 {
9177 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
9178
9179 if (!TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
9180 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9181 DeclAccessPair dap;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009182 if (FunctionDecl* Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009183 OvlExpr, false, &dap) ) {
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00009184
9185 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
9186 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
9187 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function
9188 // found is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was
9189 // the target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
9190 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
9191
9192 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
9193 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
9194 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
9195 return;
9196 }
9197 }
9198
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009199 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap,Fn));
9200 }
Douglas Gregor83314aa2009-07-08 20:55:45 +00009201 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009202 return;
Douglas Gregor83314aa2009-07-08 20:55:45 +00009203 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009204
9205 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
9206 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009207
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009208 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
9209 // C++ [over.over]p4:
9210 // If more than one function is selected, [...]
9211 if (Matches.size() > 1) {
9212 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
9213 EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
9214 else
9215 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
9216 }
9217 }
9218 }
9219
9220private:
9221 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
9222 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
9223 }
9224
9225 // [ToType] [Return]
9226
9227 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
9228 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
9229 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
9230 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
9231 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
9232 }
9233
9234 // return true if any matching specializations were found
9235 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
9236 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
9237 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
9238 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
9239 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
9240 // static when converting to member pointer.
9241 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9242 return false;
9243 }
9244 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9245 return false;
9246
9247 // C++ [over.over]p2:
9248 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
9249 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
9250 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
9251 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
9252 // overloaded functions considered.
9253 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00009254 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009255 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
9256 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
9257 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
9258 TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
Douglas Gregor092140a2013-04-17 08:45:07 +00009259 Info, /*InOverloadResolution=*/true)) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009260 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
9261 (void)Result;
9262 return false;
9263 }
9264
Douglas Gregor092140a2013-04-17 08:45:07 +00009265 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match or
9266 // compatible pointer-to-function arguments that would be adjusted by ICS.
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009267 // This function template specicalization works.
9268 Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor092140a2013-04-17 08:45:07 +00009269 assert(S.isSameOrCompatibleFunctionType(
9270 Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()),
9271 Context.getCanonicalType(TargetFunctionType)));
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009272 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
9273 return true;
9274 }
9275
9276 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
9277 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
Chandler Carruthbd647292009-12-29 06:17:27 +00009278 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00009279 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
9280 // when converting to member pointer.
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009281 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9282 return false;
9283 }
9284 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9285 return false;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009286
Chandler Carruthbd647292009-12-29 06:17:27 +00009287 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009288 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA)
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00009289 if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext))
9290 if (S.CheckCUDATarget(Caller, FunDecl))
9291 return false;
9292
Richard Smith60e141e2013-05-04 07:00:32 +00009293 // If any candidate has a placeholder return type, trigger its deduction
9294 // now.
9295 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y &&
9296 FunDecl->getResultType()->isUndeducedType() &&
9297 S.DeduceReturnType(FunDecl, SourceExpr->getLocStart(), Complain))
9298 return false;
9299
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00009300 QualType ResultTy;
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009301 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType,
9302 FunDecl->getType()) ||
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00009303 S.IsNoReturnConversion(FunDecl->getType(), TargetFunctionType,
9304 ResultTy)) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009305 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair,
9306 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
Douglas Gregor00aeb522009-07-08 23:33:52 +00009307 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009308 return true;
Douglas Gregor00aeb522009-07-08 23:33:52 +00009309 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009310 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009311
9312 return false;
9313 }
9314
9315 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
9316 bool Ret = false;
9317
9318 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
9319 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
9320 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
9321 return false;
9322
9323 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
9324 E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
9325 I != E; ++I) {
9326 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
9327 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
9328
9329 // C++ [over.over]p3:
9330 // Non-member functions and static member functions match
9331 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
9332 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of
9333 // type "pointer-to-member-function."
9334 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
9335 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
9336 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
9337 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
9338 Ret = true;
9339 }
9340 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
9341 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
9342 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
9343 Ret = true;
9344 }
9345 assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
9346 return Ret;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009347 }
9348
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009349 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00009350 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
9351 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template
9352 // specialization whose function template is more specialized
9353 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial
9354 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
9355
9356 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
9357 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
9358 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
9359 // best function template (if it exists).
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009360
9361 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
9362 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
9363 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009364
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009365 UnresolvedSetIterator Result =
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009366 S.getMostSpecialized(MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(),
9367 TPOC_Other, 0, SourceExpr->getLocStart(),
9368 S.PDiag(),
9369 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
9370 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(),
9371 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
9372 << (unsigned) oc_function_template,
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00009373 Complain, TargetFunctionType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009374
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009375 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
9376 // Make it the first and only element
9377 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
9378 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
9379 Matches.resize(1);
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009380 }
9381 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009382
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009383 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
9384 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are
9385 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
9386 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
9387 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == 0)
9388 ++I;
9389 else {
9390 Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
9391 Matches.set_size(N);
9392 }
9393 }
9394 }
9395
9396public:
9397 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
9398 assert(Matches.empty());
9399 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
9400 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
9401 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00009402 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009403 }
9404
9405 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
9406 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
9407 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
9408 }
9409
9410 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
9411 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
9412 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
9413 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
9414 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
9415 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
9416 }
9417
9418 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
9419 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
9420 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
9421 }
9422
9423 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
9424 assert(Matches.size() > 1);
9425 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
9426 << OvlExpr->getName()
9427 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00009428 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009429 }
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009430
9431 bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); }
9432
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009433 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
9434
9435 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
9436 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
9437 return Matches[0].second;
9438 }
9439
9440 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
9441 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
9442 return &Matches[0].first;
9443 }
9444};
9445
9446/// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
9447/// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
9448/// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
9449/// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
9450///
9451/// @code
9452/// int f(double);
9453/// int f(int);
9454///
9455/// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
9456/// @endcode
9457///
9458/// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
9459/// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
9460/// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
9461FunctionDecl *
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009462Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr,
9463 QualType TargetType,
9464 bool Complain,
9465 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult,
9466 bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009467 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009468
9469 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType,
9470 Complain);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009471 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
9472 FunctionDecl* Fn = 0;
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009473 if (NumMatches == 0 && Complain) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009474 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
9475 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
9476 else
9477 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
9478 }
9479 else if (NumMatches > 1 && Complain)
9480 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
9481 else if (NumMatches == 1) {
9482 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
9483 assert(Fn);
9484 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
Douglas Gregor9b623632010-10-12 23:32:35 +00009485 if (Complain)
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009486 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
Sebastian Redl07ab2022009-10-17 21:12:09 +00009487 }
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009488
9489 if (pHadMultipleCandidates)
9490 *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates();
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009491 return Fn;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009492}
9493
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009494/// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009495/// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
9496///
9497/// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
9498/// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009499/// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009500/// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009501FunctionDecl *
9502Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl,
9503 bool Complain,
9504 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) {
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009505 // C++ [over.over]p1:
9506 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
9507 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009508 // C++ [over.over]p1:
9509 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
9510 // operator.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009511
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009512 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009513 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009514 return 0;
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00009515
9516 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009517 ovl->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009518
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009519 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
9520 // whose type matches exactly.
9521 FunctionDecl *Matched = 0;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009522 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(),
9523 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009524 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
9525 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009526 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
9527 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
9528 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009529 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
Douglas Gregor66a8c9a2010-07-14 23:20:53 +00009530 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
9531 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009532
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009533 // C++ [over.over]p2:
9534 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
9535 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
9536 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
9537 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
9538 // overloaded functions considered.
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009539 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00009540 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(ovl->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009541 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
9542 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor092140a2013-04-17 08:45:07 +00009543 Specialization, Info,
9544 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true)) {
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009545 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
9546 (void)Result;
9547 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009548 }
9549
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009550 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?");
9551
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009552 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009553 if (Matched) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009554 if (Complain) {
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009555 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
9556 << ovl->getName();
9557 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009558 }
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009559 return 0;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009560 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009561
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009562 Matched = Specialization;
9563 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair();
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009564 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009565
Richard Smith60e141e2013-05-04 07:00:32 +00009566 if (Matched && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y &&
9567 Matched->getResultType()->isUndeducedType() &&
9568 DeduceReturnType(Matched, ovl->getExprLoc(), Complain))
9569 return 0;
9570
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009571 return Matched;
9572}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009573
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009574
9575
9576
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009577// Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved
9578// because it identifies a single function template specialization.
9579//
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009580// Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009581//
9582// Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the
9583// expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded. Always
9584// returns true if 'complain' is set.
9585bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9586 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion,
9587 bool complain, const SourceRange& OpRangeForComplaining,
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009588 QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009589 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) {
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009590 assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009591
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009592 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get());
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009593
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009594 DeclAccessPair found;
9595 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
9596 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9597 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) {
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00009598 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getLocStart())) {
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009599 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9600 return true;
9601 }
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009602
9603 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're
9604 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member.
9605 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which
9606 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this.
9607 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer &&
9608 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) &&
9609 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) {
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009610 if (!complain) return false;
9611
9612 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(),
9613 diag::err_bound_member_function)
9614 << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange();
9615
9616 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of
9617 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression
9618 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type).
9619 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why
9620 // the static candidates were rejected.
9621 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9622 return true;
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009623 }
Douglas Gregordb2eae62011-03-16 19:16:25 +00009624
Sylvestre Ledru43e3dee2012-07-31 06:56:50 +00009625 // Fix the expression to refer to 'fn'.
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009626 SingleFunctionExpression =
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009627 Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.take(), found, fn));
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009628
9629 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay.
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009630 if (doFunctionPointerConverion) {
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009631 SingleFunctionExpression =
9632 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.take());
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009633 if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) {
9634 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9635 return true;
9636 }
9637 }
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009638 }
9639
9640 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
9641 if (complain) {
9642 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
9643 << ovl.Expression->getName()
9644 << DestTypeForComplaining
9645 << OpRangeForComplaining
9646 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009647 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get());
9648
9649 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9650 return true;
9651 }
9652
9653 return false;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009654 }
9655
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009656 SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression;
9657 return true;
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009658}
9659
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009660/// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set.
9661static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009662 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00009663 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009664 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009665 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009666 bool PartialOverloading,
9667 bool KnownValid) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009668 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009669 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
9670 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
9671
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009672 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009673 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
9674 assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?");
9675 return;
9676 }
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009677 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false,
9678 PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009679 return;
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009680 }
9681
9682 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
9683 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009684 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009685 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009686 return;
9687 }
9688
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009689 assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009690}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009691
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009692/// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
9693/// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009694void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009695 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009696 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
9697 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009698
9699#ifndef NDEBUG
9700 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
9701 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009702 //
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009703 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
9704 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
9705 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
9706 //
9707 // -- a declaration of a class member, or
9708 //
9709 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009710 // using-declaration, or
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009711 //
9712 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
9713 // template
9714 //
9715 // then Y is empty.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009716
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009717 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
9718 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
9719 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
9720 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
9721 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
9722 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
9723 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009724 }
9725 }
9726#endif
9727
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009728 // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
9729 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00009730 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009731 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9732 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
9733 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
9734 }
9735
9736 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
9737 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009738 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
9739 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading,
9740 /*KnownValid*/ true);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009741
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009742 if (ULE->requiresADL())
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009743 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), /*Operator*/ false,
Richard Smithf5cd5cc2012-02-25 06:24:24 +00009744 ULE->getExprLoc(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009745 Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00009746 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009747}
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009748
Richard Smithd3ff3252013-06-12 22:56:54 +00009749/// Determine whether a declaration with the specified name could be moved into
9750/// a different namespace.
9751static bool canBeDeclaredInNamespace(const DeclarationName &Name) {
9752 switch (Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator()) {
9753 case OO_New: case OO_Array_New:
9754 case OO_Delete: case OO_Array_Delete:
9755 return false;
9756
9757 default:
9758 return true;
9759 }
9760}
9761
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009762/// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a
9763/// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template
9764/// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not
9765/// correctly implement two-stage name lookup.
9766///
9767/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
9768static bool
9769DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc,
9770 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
9771 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009772 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009773 if (SemaRef.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() || !SS.isEmpty())
9774 return false;
9775
9776 for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
Nick Lewycky5a7120c2012-03-14 20:41:00 +00009777 if (DC->isTransparentContext())
9778 continue;
9779
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009780 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
9781
9782 if (!R.empty()) {
9783 R.suppressDiagnostics();
9784
9785 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
9786 // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better
9787 // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup.
9788 R.clear();
9789 return false;
9790 }
9791
9792 OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc);
9793 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
9794 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009795 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009796 Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009797
9798 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009799 if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009800 // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions
9801 // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway.
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009802 R.clear();
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009803 return false;
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009804 }
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009805
9806 // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest
9807 // declaring the function there instead.
9808 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces;
9809 Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses;
John McCall42f48fb2012-08-24 20:38:34 +00009810 SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(FnLoc, Args,
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009811 AssociatedNamespaces,
9812 AssociatedClasses);
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009813 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces;
Richard Smithd3ff3252013-06-12 22:56:54 +00009814 if (canBeDeclaredInNamespace(R.getLookupName())) {
9815 DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace();
9816 for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator
9817 it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(),
9818 end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) {
9819 // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'.
9820 if (Std && Std->Encloses(*it))
9821 continue;
Richard Smith19e0d952012-12-22 02:46:14 +00009822
Richard Smithd3ff3252013-06-12 22:56:54 +00009823 // Never suggest declaring a function within a namespace with a
9824 // reserved name, like __gnu_cxx.
9825 NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(*it);
9826 if (NS &&
9827 NS->getQualifiedNameAsString().find("__") != std::string::npos)
9828 continue;
9829
9830 SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it);
9831 }
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009832 }
9833
9834 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9835 << R.getLookupName();
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009836 if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009837 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9838 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9839 << R.getLookupName() << 0;
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009840 } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009841 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9842 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009843 << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin();
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009844 } else {
9845 // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here,
9846 // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce
9847 // a localized representation of a list of items.
9848 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9849 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9850 << R.getLookupName() << 2;
9851 }
9852
9853 // Try to recover by calling this function.
9854 return true;
9855 }
9856
9857 R.clear();
9858 }
9859
9860 return false;
9861}
9862
9863/// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a
9864/// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template
9865/// was defined.
9866///
9867/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
9868static bool
9869DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
9870 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009871 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009872 DeclarationName OpName =
9873 SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
9874 LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName);
9875 return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009876 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/0, Args);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009877}
9878
Kaelyn Uhrain60a09dc2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009879namespace {
9880// Callback to limit the allowed keywords and to only accept typo corrections
9881// that are keywords or whose decls refer to functions (or template functions)
9882// that accept the given number of arguments.
9883class RecoveryCallCCC : public CorrectionCandidateCallback {
9884 public:
9885 RecoveryCallCCC(Sema &SemaRef, unsigned NumArgs, bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs)
9886 : NumArgs(NumArgs), HasExplicitTemplateArgs(HasExplicitTemplateArgs) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009887 WantTypeSpecifiers = SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
Kaelyn Uhrain60a09dc2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009888 WantRemainingKeywords = false;
9889 }
9890
9891 virtual bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) {
9892 if (!candidate.getCorrectionDecl())
9893 return candidate.isKeyword();
9894
9895 for (TypoCorrection::const_decl_iterator DI = candidate.begin(),
9896 DIEnd = candidate.end(); DI != DIEnd; ++DI) {
9897 FunctionDecl *FD = 0;
9898 NamedDecl *ND = (*DI)->getUnderlyingDecl();
9899 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND))
9900 FD = FTD->getTemplatedDecl();
9901 if (!HasExplicitTemplateArgs && !FD) {
9902 if (!(FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(ND)) && isa<ValueDecl>(ND)) {
9903 // If the Decl is neither a function nor a template function,
9904 // determine if it is a pointer or reference to a function. If so,
9905 // check against the number of arguments expected for the pointee.
9906 QualType ValType = cast<ValueDecl>(ND)->getType();
9907 if (ValType->isAnyPointerType() || ValType->isReferenceType())
9908 ValType = ValType->getPointeeType();
9909 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = ValType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
9910 if (FPT->getNumArgs() == NumArgs)
9911 return true;
9912 }
9913 }
9914 if (FD && FD->getNumParams() >= NumArgs &&
9915 FD->getMinRequiredArguments() <= NumArgs)
9916 return true;
9917 }
9918 return false;
9919 }
9920
9921 private:
9922 unsigned NumArgs;
9923 bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs;
9924};
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009925
9926// Callback that effectively disabled typo correction
9927class NoTypoCorrectionCCC : public CorrectionCandidateCallback {
9928 public:
9929 NoTypoCorrectionCCC() {
9930 WantTypeSpecifiers = false;
9931 WantExpressionKeywords = false;
9932 WantCXXNamedCasts = false;
9933 WantRemainingKeywords = false;
9934 }
9935
9936 virtual bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) {
9937 return false;
9938 }
9939};
Richard Smithe49ff3e2012-09-25 04:46:05 +00009940
9941class BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII {
9942 Sema &SemaRef;
9943public:
9944 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII(Sema &S) : SemaRef(S) {
9945 assert(SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr == false);
9946 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = true;
9947 }
9948
9949 ~BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII() {
9950 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = false;
9951 }
9952};
9953
Kaelyn Uhrain60a09dc2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009954}
9955
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009956/// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
9957///
9958/// Returns true if new candidates were found.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009959static ExprResult
Douglas Gregor1aae80b2010-04-14 20:27:54 +00009960BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009961 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
9962 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009963 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009964 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009965 bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
Richard Smithe49ff3e2012-09-25 04:46:05 +00009966 // Do not try to recover if it is already building a recovery call.
9967 // This stops infinite loops for template instantiations like
9968 //
9969 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(t)) {}
9970 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(&t)) {}
9971 //
9972 if (SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr)
9973 return ExprError();
9974 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII RCE(SemaRef);
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009975
9976 CXXScopeSpec SS;
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009977 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009978 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009979
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009980 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009981 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009982 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9983 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
9984 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
9985 }
9986
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009987 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
9988 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009989 RecoveryCallCCC Validator(SemaRef, Args.size(), ExplicitTemplateArgs != 0);
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009990 NoTypoCorrectionCCC RejectAll;
9991 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC = AllowTypoCorrection ?
9992 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&Validator :
9993 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&RejectAll;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009994 if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009995 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args) &&
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009996 (!EmptyLookup ||
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009997 SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, *CCC,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009998 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args)))
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009999 return ExprError();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010000
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010001 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
10002
10003 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the
10004 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +000010005 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010006 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000010007 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc,
10008 R, ExplicitTemplateArgs);
Abramo Bagnara9d9922a2012-02-06 14:31:00 +000010009 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid())
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000010010 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false,
Abramo Bagnara9d9922a2012-02-06 14:31:00 +000010011 ExplicitTemplateArgs);
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010012 else
10013 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
10014
10015 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +000010016 return ExprError();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010017
10018 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010019 // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010020 // end up here.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010021 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ 0, NewFn.take(), LParenLoc,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010022 MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()),
10023 RParenLoc);
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010024}
Douglas Gregord7a95972010-06-08 17:35:15 +000010025
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010026/// \brief Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from
10027/// the given function.
10028/// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set.
10029bool Sema::buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
10030 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010031 MultiExprArg Args,
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010032 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
10033 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
10034 ExprResult *Result) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010035#ifndef NDEBUG
10036 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
10037 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
10038 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
10039
10040 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
10041 // Verify that this was correctly set up.
10042 FunctionDecl *F;
10043 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
10044 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
10045 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +000010046 llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin");
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010047
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010048 // We don't perform ADL in C.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +000010049 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +000010050 }
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010051#endif
10052
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010053 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010054 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) {
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010055 *Result = ExprError();
10056 return true;
10057 }
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +000010058
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010059 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
10060 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010061 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, *CandidateSet);
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010062
10063 // If we found nothing, try to recover.
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010064 // BuildRecoveryCallExpr diagnoses the error itself, so we just bail
10065 // out if it fails.
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010066 if (CandidateSet->empty()) {
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +000010067 // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function then
10068 // create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name lookup
Francois Pichet0f74d1e2011-09-07 00:14:57 +000010069 // to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent base
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +000010070 // classes.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +000010071 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftMode && CurContext->isDependentContext() &&
Francois Pichetc8ff9152011-11-25 01:10:54 +000010072 (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) {
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010073 CallExpr *CE = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args,
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010074 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
10075 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +000010076 CE->setTypeDependent(true);
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010077 *Result = Owned(CE);
10078 return true;
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +000010079 }
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010080 return false;
Francois Pichet0f74d1e2011-09-07 00:14:57 +000010081 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010082
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010083 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010084 return false;
10085}
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010086
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010087/// FinishOverloadedCallExpr - given an OverloadCandidateSet, builds and returns
10088/// the completed call expression. If overload resolution fails, emits
10089/// diagnostics and returns ExprError()
10090static ExprResult FinishOverloadedCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
10091 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
10092 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010093 MultiExprArg Args,
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010094 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
10095 Expr *ExecConfig,
10096 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
10097 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best,
10098 OverloadingResult OverloadResult,
10099 bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
10100 if (CandidateSet->empty())
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010101 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args,
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010102 RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true,
10103 AllowTypoCorrection);
10104
10105 switch (OverloadResult) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010106 case OR_Success: {
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010107 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010108 SemaRef.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, (*Best)->FoundDecl);
Richard Smith82f145d2013-05-04 06:44:46 +000010109 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc()))
10110 return ExprError();
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010111 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010112 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
10113 ExecConfig);
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010114 }
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010115
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010116 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
10117 // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might
10118 // have meant to call.
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010119 ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010120 Args, RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +000010121 /*EmptyLookup=*/false,
10122 AllowTypoCorrection);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010123 if (!Recovery.isInvalid())
10124 return Recovery;
10125
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010126 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010127 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010128 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010129 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010130 break;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010131 }
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010132
10133 case OR_Ambiguous:
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010134 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010135 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010136 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010137 break;
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010138
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010139 case OR_Deleted: {
10140 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
10141 << (*Best)->Function->isDeleted()
10142 << ULE->getName()
10143 << SemaRef.getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix((*Best)->Function)
10144 << Fn->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010145 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis0d579b62011-11-04 15:58:13 +000010146
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010147 // We emitted an error for the unvailable/deleted function call but keep
10148 // the call in the AST.
10149 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
10150 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010151 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
10152 ExecConfig);
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010153 }
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010154 }
10155
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +000010156 // Overload resolution failed.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010157 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010158}
10159
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010160/// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn
10161/// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
10162/// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
10163/// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
10164/// the call expression produced by overload resolution.
10165/// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError.
10166ExprResult Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
10167 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
10168 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010169 MultiExprArg Args,
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010170 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
10171 Expr *ExecConfig,
10172 bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
10173 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc());
10174 ExprResult result;
10175
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010176 if (buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, ULE, Args, LParenLoc, &CandidateSet,
10177 &result))
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010178 return result;
10179
10180 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
10181 OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
10182 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best);
10183
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010184 return FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args,
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010185 RParenLoc, ExecConfig, &CandidateSet,
10186 &Best, OverloadResult,
10187 AllowTypoCorrection);
10188}
10189
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010190static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +000010191 return Functions.size() > 1 ||
10192 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
10193}
10194
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010195/// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
10196/// operator.
10197///
10198/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
10199///
10200/// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
10201/// operator.
10202///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +000010203/// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010204/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
10205/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
10206/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
10207/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
10208/// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
10209///
James Dennett8da16872012-06-22 10:32:46 +000010210/// \param Input The input argument.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010211ExprResult
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010212Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn,
10213 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010214 Expr *Input) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010215 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010216
10217 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10218 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
10219 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010220 // TODO: provide better source location info.
10221 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010222
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010223 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input))
10224 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010225
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010226 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, 0 };
10227 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010228
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010229 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
10230 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
10231 // post-decrement.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010232 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010233 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +000010234 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
10235 SourceLocation());
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010236 NumArgs = 2;
10237 }
10238
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010239 ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, NumArgs);
10240
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010241 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregor1ec8ef72010-06-17 15:46:20 +000010242 if (Fns.empty())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010243 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010244 Opc,
Douglas Gregor1ec8ef72010-06-17 15:46:20 +000010245 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010246 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor1ec8ef72010-06-17 15:46:20 +000010247 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010248
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010249 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010250 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregorbebbe0d2010-12-15 01:34:56 +000010251 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010252 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010253 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
10254 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010255 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, ArgsArray,
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010256 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010257 VK_RValue,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010258 OpLoc, false));
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010259 }
10260
10261 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010262 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010263
10264 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010265 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, ArgsArray, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010266
10267 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010268 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010269
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010270 // Add candidates from ADL.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010271 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true, OpLoc,
10272 ArgsArray, /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010273 CandidateSet);
10274
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010275 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010276 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010277
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010278 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10279
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010280 // Perform overload resolution.
10281 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010282 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010283 case OR_Success: {
10284 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10285 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010286
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010287 if (FnDecl) {
10288 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10289 // operator.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010290
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010291 // Convert the arguments.
10292 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010293 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall5357b612010-01-28 01:42:12 +000010294
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010295 ExprResult InputRes =
10296 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/0,
10297 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10298 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010299 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010300 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010301 } else {
10302 // Convert the arguments.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010303 ExprResult InputInit
Douglas Gregore1a5c172009-12-23 17:40:29 +000010304 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000010305 Context,
Douglas Gregorbaecfed2009-12-23 00:02:00 +000010306 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010307 SourceLocation(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010308 Input);
Douglas Gregore1a5c172009-12-23 17:40:29 +000010309 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010310 return ExprError();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010311 Input = InputInit.take();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010312 }
10313
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010314 // Determine the result type.
10315 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
10316 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10317 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010318
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010319 // Build the actual expression node.
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000010320 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, Best->FoundDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010321 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010322 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10323 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010324
Eli Friedman4c3b8962009-11-18 03:58:17 +000010325 Args[0] = Input;
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010326 CallExpr *TheCall =
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010327 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(), ArgsArray,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010328 ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, false);
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010329
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010330 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson26a2a072009-10-13 21:19:37 +000010331 FnDecl))
10332 return ExprError();
10333
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010334 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010335 } else {
10336 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10337 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10338 // operator node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010339 ExprResult InputRes =
10340 PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10341 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10342 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
10343 return ExprError();
10344 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010345 break;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010346 }
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010347 }
10348
10349 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010350 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
10351 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
10352 // defined too late to be candidates.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010353 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray))
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010354 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
10355 return ExprError();
10356
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010357 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
10358 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
10359 break;
10360
10361 case OR_Ambiguous:
10362 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
10363 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10364 << Input->getType()
10365 << Input->getSourceRange();
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010366 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, ArgsArray,
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010367 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
10368 return ExprError();
10369
10370 case OR_Deleted:
10371 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10372 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
10373 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10374 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
10375 << Input->getSourceRange();
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010376 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, ArgsArray,
Eli Friedman1795d372011-08-26 19:46:22 +000010377 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010378 return ExprError();
10379 }
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010380
10381 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
10382 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
10383 // build a built-in operation.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010384 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010385}
10386
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010387/// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
10388/// operator.
10389///
10390/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
10391///
10392/// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
10393/// operator.
10394///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +000010395/// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010396/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
10397/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
10398/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
10399/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
10400/// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
10401///
10402/// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
10403/// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010404ExprResult
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010405Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010406 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010407 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010408 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010409 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010410 LHS=RHS=0; //Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010411
10412 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
10413 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10414 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
10415
10416 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
10417 // expression.
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010418 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010419 if (Fns.empty()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010420 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010421 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010422 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign)
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010423 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010424 Context.DependentTy,
10425 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010426 OpLoc,
10427 FPFeatures.fp_contract));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010428
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010429 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
10430 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010431 VK_LValue,
10432 OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010433 Context.DependentTy,
10434 Context.DependentTy,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010435 OpLoc,
10436 FPFeatures.fp_contract));
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010437 }
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010438
10439 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010440 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010441 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
10442 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010443 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010444 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
10445 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
10446 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010447 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010448 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, Args,
10449 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
10450 OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract));
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010451 }
10452
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010453 // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS.
10454 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
10455 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010456
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +000010457 // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should
10458 // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS.
10459 assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty);
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010460 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
10461 return ExprError();
10462
Sebastian Redl275c2b42009-11-18 23:10:33 +000010463 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
10464 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
10465 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
10466 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
10467 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
10468 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010469 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010470 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010471
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010472 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
10473 // create a built-in binary operator.
10474 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
10475 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
10476
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010477 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010478 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010479
10480 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010481 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010482
10483 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010484 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010485
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010486 // Add candidates from ADL.
10487 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010488 OpLoc, Args,
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010489 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
10490 CandidateSet);
10491
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010492 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010493 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010494
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010495 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10496
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010497 // Perform overload resolution.
10498 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010499 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +000010500 case OR_Success: {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010501 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10502 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
10503
10504 if (FnDecl) {
10505 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10506 // operator.
10507
10508 // Convert the arguments.
10509 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCall5357b612010-01-28 01:42:12 +000010510 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010511 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall5357b612010-01-28 01:42:12 +000010512
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010513 ExprResult Arg1 =
10514 PerformCopyInitialization(
10515 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
10516 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
10517 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010518 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010519 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010520
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010521 ExprResult Arg0 =
10522 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
10523 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10524 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010525 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010526 Args[0] = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010527 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010528 } else {
10529 // Convert the arguments.
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010530 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
10531 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
10532 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
10533 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[0]));
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010534 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010535 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010536
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010537 ExprResult Arg1 =
10538 PerformCopyInitialization(
10539 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
10540 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
10541 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010542 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
10543 return ExprError();
10544 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
10545 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010546 }
10547
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010548 // Determine the result type.
10549 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
10550 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10551 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010552
10553 // Build the actual expression node.
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010554 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000010555 Best->FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010556 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010557 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10558 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010559
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010560 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010561 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010562 Args, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc,
10563 FPFeatures.fp_contract);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010564
10565 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson15ea3782009-10-13 22:43:21 +000010566 FnDecl))
10567 return ExprError();
10568
Nick Lewycky9b7ea0d2013-01-24 02:03:08 +000010569 ArrayRef<const Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, 2);
10570 // Cut off the implicit 'this'.
10571 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl))
10572 ArgsArray = ArgsArray.slice(1);
10573 checkCall(FnDecl, ArgsArray, 0, isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl), OpLoc,
10574 TheCall->getSourceRange(), VariadicDoesNotApply);
10575
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010576 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010577 } else {
10578 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10579 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10580 // operator node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010581 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
10582 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10583 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10584 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010585 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010586 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010587
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010588 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
10589 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
10590 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
10591 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
10592 return ExprError();
10593 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010594 break;
10595 }
10596 }
10597
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010598 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
10599 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
10600 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
10601 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
10602 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010603 if (Opc == BO_Comma)
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010604 break;
10605
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010606 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment
10607 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
10608 // no overloaded assignment operator found
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010609 ExprResult Result = ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010610 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010611 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
Sebastian Redl8593c782009-05-21 11:50:50 +000010612 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
10613 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010614 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010615 } else {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010616 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
10617 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
10618 // defined too late to be candidates.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010619 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args))
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010620 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
10621 return ExprError();
10622
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010623 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
10624 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
10625 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Sebastian Redl8593c782009-05-21 11:50:50 +000010626 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010627 assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010628 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
10629 if (Result.isInvalid())
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010630 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010631 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Benjamin Kramer3fe198b2012-08-23 21:35:17 +000010632 return Result;
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010633 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010634
10635 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010636 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010637 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010638 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010639 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010640 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010641 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010642 return ExprError();
10643
10644 case OR_Deleted:
Douglas Gregore4e68d42012-02-15 19:33:52 +000010645 if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) {
10646 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
10647 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper)
Richard Smith0f46e642012-12-28 12:23:24 +000010648 << Context.getRecordType(Method->getParent())
10649 << getSpecialMember(Method);
Richard Smith5bdaac52012-04-02 20:59:25 +000010650
Richard Smith0f46e642012-12-28 12:23:24 +000010651 // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just
10652 // explain why it's deleted.
10653 NoteDeletedFunction(Method);
10654 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore4e68d42012-02-15 19:33:52 +000010655 } else {
10656 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10657 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
10658 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10659 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
10660 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
10661 }
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010662 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
Eli Friedman1795d372011-08-26 19:46:22 +000010663 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010664 return ExprError();
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +000010665 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010666
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010667 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010668 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010669}
10670
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010671ExprResult
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010672Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
10673 SourceLocation RLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010674 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
10675 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010676 DeclarationName OpName =
10677 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
10678
10679 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
10680 // expression.
10681 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
10682
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010683 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010684 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
10685 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
10686 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010687 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregorbebbe0d2010-12-15 01:34:56 +000010688 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010689 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010690 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
10691 UnresolvedSetIterator(),
10692 UnresolvedSetIterator());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000010693 // Can't add any actual overloads yet
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010694
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010695 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn,
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010696 Args,
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010697 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010698 VK_RValue,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010699 RLoc, false));
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010700 }
10701
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010702 // Handle placeholders on both operands.
10703 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
10704 return ExprError();
10705 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
10706 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010707
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010708 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010709 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010710
10711 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
10712
10713 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010714 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010715
10716 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010717 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010718
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010719 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10720
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010721 // Perform overload resolution.
10722 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010723 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010724 case OR_Success: {
10725 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10726 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
10727
10728 if (FnDecl) {
10729 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10730 // operator.
10731
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010732 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010733
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010734 // Convert the arguments.
10735 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010736 ExprResult Arg0 =
10737 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
10738 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10739 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010740 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010741 Args[0] = Arg0.take();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010742
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010743 // Convert the arguments.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010744 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010745 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000010746 Context,
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010747 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010748 SourceLocation(),
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010749 Owned(Args[1]));
10750 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
10751 return ExprError();
10752
10753 Args[1] = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
10754
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010755 // Determine the result type
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010756 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
10757 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10758 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010759
10760 // Build the actual expression node.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010761 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc);
10762 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010763 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000010764 Best->FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010765 HadMultipleCandidates,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010766 OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
10767 OpLocInfo.getInfo());
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010768 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10769 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010770
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010771 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
10772 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010773 FnExpr.take(), Args,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010774 ResultTy, VK, RLoc,
10775 false);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010776
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010777 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), LLoc, TheCall,
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010778 FnDecl))
10779 return ExprError();
10780
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010781 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010782 } else {
10783 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10784 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10785 // operator node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010786 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
10787 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10788 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10789 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010790 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010791 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
10792
10793 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
10794 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
10795 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
10796 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
10797 return ExprError();
10798 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010799
10800 break;
10801 }
10802 }
10803
10804 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010805 if (CandidateSet.empty())
10806 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
10807 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
10808 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
10809 else
10810 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
10811 << Args[0]->getType()
10812 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010813 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010814 "[]", LLoc);
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010815 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010816 }
10817
10818 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010819 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010820 << "[]"
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010821 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
10822 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010823 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010824 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010825 return ExprError();
10826
10827 case OR_Deleted:
10828 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10829 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000010830 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010831 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010832 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010833 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010834 return ExprError();
10835 }
10836
10837 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010838 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010839}
10840
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010841/// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
10842/// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
10843/// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
10844/// arguments to the function call (not including the object
10845/// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010846/// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
10847/// member function.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010848ExprResult
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010849Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010850 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
10851 MultiExprArg Args,
10852 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010853 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy ||
10854 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
10855
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010856 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
10857 // argument and the member function we're referring to.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010858 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010859
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010860 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
10861 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) {
10862 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy);
10863 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI);
10864
10865 QualType fnType =
10866 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
10867
10868 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
10869 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context);
10870 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getResultType());
10871
10872 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the
10873 // member function we're calling.
10874 Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals());
10875
10876 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType();
10877 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI)
10878 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
10879 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers();
10880
10881 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals;
10882 difference.removeObjCGCAttr();
10883 difference.removeAddressSpace();
10884 if (difference) {
10885 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString();
10886 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals)
10887 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType()
10888 << qualsString
10889 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2);
10890 }
10891
10892 CXXMemberCallExpr *call
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010893 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args,
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010894 resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc);
10895
10896 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getResultType(),
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000010897 op->getRHS()->getLocStart(),
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010898 call, 0))
10899 return ExprError();
10900
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010901 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, 0, proto, Args, RParenLoc))
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010902 return ExprError();
10903
Richard Trieue2a90b82013-06-22 02:30:38 +000010904 if (CheckOtherCall(call, proto))
10905 return ExprError();
10906
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010907 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call);
10908 }
10909
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010910 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010911 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts))
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010912 return ExprError();
10913
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010914 MemberExpr *MemExpr;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010915 CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0;
John McCallbb6fb462010-04-08 00:13:37 +000010916 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_public);
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010917 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010918 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
10919 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010920 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010921 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010922 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010923 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010924 } else {
10925 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010926 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010927
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010928 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010929 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
10930 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
10931 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010932
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010933 // Add overload candidates
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010934 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010935
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010936 // FIXME: avoid copy.
10937 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
10938 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10939 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
10940 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
10941 }
10942
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010943 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
10944 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
10945
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010946 NamedDecl *Func = *I;
10947 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
10948 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
10949 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
10950
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010951
Francois Pichetdbee3412011-01-18 05:04:39 +000010952 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +000010953 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010954 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(),
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010955 Args, CandidateSet);
Francois Pichetdbee3412011-01-18 05:04:39 +000010956 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
Douglas Gregor3eefb1c2009-10-24 04:59:53 +000010957 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
10958 // non-template member function.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010959 if (TemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregor3eefb1c2009-10-24 04:59:53 +000010960 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010961
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010962 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010963 ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010964 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000010965 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010966 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func),
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010967 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010968 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010969 Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +000010970 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000010971 }
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +000010972 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010973
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010974 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
10975
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010976 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
10977
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010978 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010979 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(),
Nick Lewycky7663f392010-11-20 01:29:55 +000010980 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010981 case OR_Success:
10982 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010983 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010984 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
Richard Smith82f145d2013-05-04 06:44:46 +000010985 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()))
10986 return ExprError();
Faisal Valid570a922013-06-15 11:54:37 +000010987 // If FoundDecl is different from Method (such as if one is a template
10988 // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is
10989 // called on both.
10990 // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying
10991 // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl
10992 // being used.
10993 if (Method != FoundDecl.getDecl() &&
10994 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Method, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()))
10995 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010996 break;
10997
10998 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010999 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011000 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +000011001 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011002 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011003 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011004 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011005
11006 case OR_Ambiguous:
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011007 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +000011008 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011009 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011010 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011011 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011012
11013 case OR_Deleted:
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011014 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011015 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000011016 << DeclName
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000011017 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000011018 << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011019 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011020 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011021 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011022 }
11023
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011024 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011025
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011026 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
11027 // non-member call based on that function.
11028 if (Method->isStatic()) {
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011029 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc, Args,
11030 RParenLoc);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011031 }
11032
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011033 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011034 }
11035
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011036 QualType ResultType = Method->getResultType();
11037 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
11038 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11039
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011040 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011041 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall =
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011042 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011043 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011044
Anders Carlssoneed3e692009-10-10 00:06:20 +000011045 // Check for a valid return type.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011046 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011047 TheCall, Method))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011048 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011049
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011050 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011051 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
11052 // it was done at lookup.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011053 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
11054 ExprResult ObjectArg =
11055 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
11056 FoundDecl, Method);
11057 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
11058 return ExprError();
11059 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.take());
11060 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011061
11062 // Convert the rest of the arguments
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011063 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
11064 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011065 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011066 RParenLoc))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011067 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011068
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011069 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args);
Eli Friedmane61eb042012-02-18 04:48:30 +000011070
Richard Smith831421f2012-06-25 20:30:08 +000011071 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011072 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson6f680272009-08-16 03:42:12 +000011073
Anders Carlsson2174d4c2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000011074 if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) ||
11075 isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) &&
11076 TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) {
11077 const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl();
11078
Chandler Carruthae198062011-06-27 08:31:58 +000011079 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
Anders Carlsson2174d4c2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000011080 Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(),
11081 diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor)
11082 << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)
11083 << MD->getParent()->getDeclName();
11084
11085 Diag(MD->getLocStart(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName();
Chandler Carruthae198062011-06-27 08:31:58 +000011086 }
Anders Carlsson2174d4c2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000011087 }
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011088 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011089}
11090
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011091/// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
11092/// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
11093/// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
11094/// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +000011095ExprResult
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011096Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
Douglas Gregor5c37de72008-12-06 00:22:45 +000011097 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011098 MultiExprArg Args,
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011099 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011100 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj))
11101 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011102 ExprResult Object = Owned(Obj);
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011103
11104 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011105 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts))
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011106 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000011107
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011108 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument");
11109 const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011110
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011111 // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
11112 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
Eli Friedman33a31382009-08-05 19:21:58 +000011113 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011114 // candidate functions includes at least the function call
11115 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
11116 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
11117 // (E).operator().
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011118 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor44b43212008-12-11 16:49:14 +000011119 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
Douglas Gregor593564b2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000011120
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011121 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +000011122 diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get()))
Douglas Gregor593564b2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000011123 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011124
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +000011125 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
11126 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
11127 R.suppressDiagnostics();
11128
Douglas Gregor593564b2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000011129 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregor3734c212009-11-07 17:23:56 +000011130 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011131 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011132 Object.get()->Classify(Context),
11133 Args, CandidateSet,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +000011134 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false);
Douglas Gregor3734c212009-11-07 17:23:56 +000011135 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011136
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011137 // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000011138 // In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function
11139 // declared in T of the form
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011140 //
11141 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
11142 //
11143 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
11144 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
Douglas Gregora967a6f2008-11-20 13:33:37 +000011145 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
11146 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
11147 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
11148 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011149 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
11150 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
11151 // functions for each conversion function declared in an
11152 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
11153 // within T by another intervening declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +000011154 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
11155 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator> Conversions
Douglas Gregor90073282010-01-11 19:36:35 +000011156 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +000011157 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
11158 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011159 NamedDecl *D = *I;
11160 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
11161 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
11162 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011163
Douglas Gregor4a27d702009-10-21 06:18:39 +000011164 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
11165 // surrogates.
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011166 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
Douglas Gregor4a27d702009-10-21 06:18:39 +000011167 continue;
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +000011168
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011169 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000011170 if (!Conv->isExplicit()) {
11171 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
11172 // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
11173 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
11174 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
11175 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011176
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000011177 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
11178 {
11179 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011180 Object.get(), Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000011181 }
11182 }
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011183 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011184
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011185 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11186
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011187 // Perform overload resolution.
11188 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011189 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011190 Best)) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011191 case OR_Success:
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011192 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
11193 // below.
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011194 break;
11195
11196 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011197 if (CandidateSet.empty())
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011198 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011199 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
11200 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011201 else
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011202 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011203 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011204 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011205 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011206 break;
11207
11208 case OR_Ambiguous:
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011209 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011210 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011211 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011212 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011213 break;
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011214
11215 case OR_Deleted:
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011216 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011217 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
11218 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011219 << Object.get()->getType()
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000011220 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011221 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011222 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011223 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011224 }
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011225
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +000011226 if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011227 return true;
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011228
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011229 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
11230
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011231 if (Best->Function == 0) {
11232 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
11233 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011234 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011235 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
11236 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
11237
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011238 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
Richard Smith82f145d2013-05-04 06:44:46 +000011239 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc))
11240 return ExprError();
Faisal Valid570a922013-06-15 11:54:37 +000011241 assert(Conv == Best->FoundDecl.getDecl() &&
11242 "Found Decl & conversion-to-functionptr should be same, right?!");
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011243 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
11244 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
11245 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011246
Fariborz Jahaniand8307b12009-09-28 18:35:46 +000011247 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
Fariborz Jahanianb7400232009-09-28 23:23:40 +000011248 // and then call it.
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011249 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl,
11250 Conv, HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +000011251 if (Call.isInvalid())
11252 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnara960809e2011-11-16 22:46:05 +000011253 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
11254 Call = Owned(ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Call.get()->getType(),
11255 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
11256 Call.get(), 0, VK_RValue));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011257
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011258 return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011259 }
11260
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011261 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall41d89032010-01-28 01:54:34 +000011262
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011263 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
11264 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
11265 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
11266 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Nico Webere0ff6902012-11-09 06:06:14 +000011267
11268 // An error diagnostic has already been printed when parsing the declaration.
Nico Weber1a52a4d2012-11-09 08:38:04 +000011269 if (Method->isInvalidDecl())
Nico Webere0ff6902012-11-09 06:06:14 +000011270 return ExprError();
11271
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011272 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
11273 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011274
11275 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011276 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = Args.size();
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011277
11278 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the
11279 // implicit object parameter is placed at the beginning of the
11280 // list).
11281 Expr **MethodArgs;
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011282 if (Args.size() < NumArgsInProto) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011283 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
11284 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgsInProto + 1];
11285 } else {
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011286 MethodArgs = new Expr*[Args.size() + 1];
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011287 }
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011288 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011289 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, e = Args.size(); ArgIdx != e; ++ArgIdx)
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011290 MethodArgs[ArgIdx + 1] = Args[ArgIdx];
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011291
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011292 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(
11293 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc);
11294 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000011295 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011296 HadMultipleCandidates,
11297 OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
11298 OpLocInfo.getInfo());
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011299 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
11300 return true;
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011301
11302 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
11303 // owned.
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011304 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
11305 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11306 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11307
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011308 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011309 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.take(),
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011310 llvm::makeArrayRef(MethodArgs, Args.size()+1),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000011311 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc, false);
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011312 delete [] MethodArgs;
11313
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011314 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), LParenLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson07d68f12009-10-13 21:49:31 +000011315 Method))
11316 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011317
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011318 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
11319 // slots in the call for them.
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011320 if (Args.size() < NumArgsInProto)
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +000011321 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto + 1);
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011322 else if (Args.size() > NumArgsInProto)
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011323 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
11324
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011325 bool IsError = false;
11326
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011327 // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011328 ExprResult ObjRes =
11329 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/0,
11330 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11331 if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
11332 IsError = true;
11333 else
Benjamin Kramer3fe198b2012-08-23 21:35:17 +000011334 Object = ObjRes;
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011335 TheCall->setArg(0, Object.take());
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011336
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011337 // Check the argument types.
11338 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011339 Expr *Arg;
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011340 if (i < Args.size()) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011341 Arg = Args[i];
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011342
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011343 // Pass the argument.
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011344
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011345 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011346 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000011347 Context,
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011348 Method->getParamDecl(i)),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011349 SourceLocation(), Arg);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011350
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011351 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
11352 Arg = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011353 } else {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011354 ExprResult DefArg
Douglas Gregord47c47d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +000011355 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
11356 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
11357 IsError = true;
11358 break;
11359 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011360
Douglas Gregord47c47d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +000011361 Arg = DefArg.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011362 }
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011363
11364 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
11365 }
11366
11367 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
11368 if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
11369 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011370 for (unsigned i = NumArgsInProto, e = Args.size(); i < e; i++) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011371 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 0);
11372 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
11373 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.take());
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011374 }
11375 }
11376
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011377 if (IsError) return true;
11378
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011379 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args);
Eli Friedmane61eb042012-02-18 04:48:30 +000011380
Richard Smith831421f2012-06-25 20:30:08 +000011381 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +000011382 return true;
11383
John McCall182f7092010-08-24 06:09:16 +000011384 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011385}
11386
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011387/// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011388/// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011389/// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011390ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011391Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011392 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
11393 "left-hand side must have class type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011394
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011395 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base))
11396 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000011397
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011398 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
11399
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011400 // C++ [over.ref]p1:
11401 //
11402 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
11403 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
11404 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the
11405 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011406 DeclarationName OpName =
11407 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011408 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc);
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +000011409 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011410
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011411 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +000011412 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base))
Eli Friedmanf43fb722009-11-18 01:28:03 +000011413 return ExprError();
11414
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +000011415 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
11416 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
11417 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Anders Carlssone30572a2009-09-10 23:18:36 +000011418
11419 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011420 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000011421 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
Dmitri Gribenko55431692013-05-05 00:41:58 +000011422 None, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011423 }
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011424
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011425 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11426
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011427 // Perform overload resolution.
11428 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011429 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011430 case OR_Success:
11431 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
11432 break;
11433
11434 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
11435 if (CandidateSet.empty())
11436 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011437 << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011438 else
11439 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011440 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011441 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011442 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011443
11444 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000011445 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
11446 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011447 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011448 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011449
11450 case OR_Deleted:
11451 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
11452 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000011453 << "->"
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000011454 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000011455 << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011456 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011457 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011458 }
11459
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000011460 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
11461
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011462 // Convert the object parameter.
11463 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011464 ExprResult BaseResult =
11465 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/0,
11466 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11467 if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011468 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011469 Base = BaseResult.take();
Douglas Gregorfc195ef2008-11-21 03:04:22 +000011470
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011471 // Build the operator call.
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000011472 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011473 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011474 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
11475 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011476
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011477 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
11478 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11479 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011480 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011481 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.take(),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000011482 Base, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, false);
Anders Carlsson15ea3782009-10-13 22:43:21 +000011483
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011484 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson15ea3782009-10-13 22:43:21 +000011485 Method))
11486 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmand5931902011-04-04 01:18:25 +000011487
11488 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011489}
11490
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011491/// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to
11492/// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results.
11493ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R,
11494 DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo,
11495 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args,
11496 SourceLocation LitEndLoc,
11497 TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
11498 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc();
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011499
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011500 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc);
11501 AddFunctionCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet, true,
11502 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011503
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011504 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11505
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011506 // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need
11507 // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template.
11508 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11509 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) {
11510 case OR_Success:
11511 case OR_Deleted:
11512 break;
11513
11514 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
11515 Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
11516 << R.getLookupName();
11517 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
11518 return ExprError();
11519
11520 case OR_Ambiguous:
11521 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) << R.getLookupName();
11522 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
11523 return ExprError();
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011524 }
11525
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011526 FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function;
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000011527 ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, Best->FoundDecl,
11528 HadMultipleCandidates,
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011529 SuffixInfo.getLoc(),
11530 SuffixInfo.getInfo());
11531 if (Fn.isInvalid())
11532 return true;
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011533
11534 // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except
11535 // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals.
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011536 Expr *ConvArgs[2];
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000011537 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011538 ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization(
11539 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)),
11540 SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]);
11541 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
11542 return true;
11543 ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.take();
11544 }
11545
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011546 QualType ResultTy = FD->getResultType();
11547 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11548 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11549
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011550 UserDefinedLiteral *UDL =
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000011551 new (Context) UserDefinedLiteral(Context, Fn.take(),
11552 llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvArgs, Args.size()),
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011553 ResultTy, VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc);
11554
11555 if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getResultType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD))
11556 return ExprError();
11557
Richard Smith831421f2012-06-25 20:30:08 +000011558 if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL, NULL))
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011559 return ExprError();
11560
11561 return MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL);
11562}
11563
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011564/// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the
11565/// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which
11566/// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument
11567/// dependent lookup.
11568/// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success,
11569/// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value
11570/// is returned.
11571Sema::ForRangeStatus
11572Sema::BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
11573 SourceLocation RangeLoc, VarDecl *Decl,
11574 BeginEndFunction BEF,
11575 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
11576 LookupResult &MemberLookup,
11577 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
11578 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr) {
11579 CandidateSet->clear();
11580 if (!MemberLookup.empty()) {
11581 ExprResult MemberRef =
11582 BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Range, Range->getType(), Loc,
11583 /*IsPtr=*/false, CXXScopeSpec(),
11584 /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
11585 /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/0,
11586 MemberLookup,
11587 /*TemplateArgs=*/0);
11588 if (MemberRef.isInvalid()) {
11589 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11590 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
11591 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
11592 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
11593 }
Dmitri Gribenko62ed8892013-05-05 20:40:26 +000011594 *CallExpr = ActOnCallExpr(S, MemberRef.get(), Loc, None, Loc, 0);
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011595 if (CallExpr->isInvalid()) {
11596 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11597 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
11598 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
11599 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
11600 }
11601 } else {
11602 UnresolvedSet<0> FoundNames;
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011603 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn =
11604 UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*NamingClass=*/0,
11605 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), NameInfo,
11606 /*NeedsADL=*/true, /*Overloaded=*/false,
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +000011607 FoundNames.begin(), FoundNames.end());
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011608
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011609 bool CandidateSetError = buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, Fn, Range, Loc,
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011610 CandidateSet, CallExpr);
11611 if (CandidateSet->empty() || CandidateSetError) {
11612 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11613 return FRS_NoViableFunction;
11614 }
11615 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11616 OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
11617 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best);
11618
11619 if (OverloadResult == OR_No_Viable_Function) {
11620 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11621 return FRS_NoViableFunction;
11622 }
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011623 *CallExpr = FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, Fn, Loc, Range,
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011624 Loc, 0, CandidateSet, &Best,
11625 OverloadResult,
11626 /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/false);
11627 if (CallExpr->isInvalid() || OverloadResult != OR_Success) {
11628 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11629 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
11630 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
11631 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
11632 }
11633 }
11634 return FRS_Success;
11635}
11636
11637
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011638/// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
11639/// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
11640/// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
11641/// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
Anders Carlsson96ad5332009-10-21 17:16:23 +000011642/// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +000011643Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011644 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011645 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011646 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
11647 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011648 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011649 return PE;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011650
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011651 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011652 }
11653
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011654 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011655 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
11656 Found, Fn);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011657 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011658 SubExpr->getType()) &&
Douglas Gregor097bfb12009-10-23 22:18:25 +000011659 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +000011660 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011661 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011662 return ICE;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011663
11664 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(),
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +000011665 ICE->getCastKind(),
11666 SubExpr, 0,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +000011667 ICE->getValueKind());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011668 }
11669
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011670 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000011671 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011672 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
Douglas Gregorb86b0572009-02-11 01:18:59 +000011673 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
11674 if (Method->isStatic()) {
11675 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
11676 // from non-member functions.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011677 } else {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000011678 // Fix the sub expression, which really has to be an
11679 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
11680 // or template.
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011681 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
11682 Found, Fn);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011683 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011684 return UnOp;
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011685
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011686 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
11687 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
11688 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
11689 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
11690
11691 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
11692 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
11693 // appropriate pointer to member type.
11694 QualType ClassType
11695 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
11696 QualType MemPtrType
11697 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
11698
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011699 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType,
11700 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
11701 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
Douglas Gregorb86b0572009-02-11 01:18:59 +000011702 }
11703 }
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011704 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
11705 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011706 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011707 return UnOp;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011708
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000011709 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011710 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011711 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011712 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011713 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011714
11715 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011716 // FIXME: avoid copy.
11717 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000011718 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011719 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
11720 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000011721 }
11722
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011723 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
11724 ULE->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000011725 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011726 Fn,
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +000011727 /*enclosing*/ false, // FIXME?
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011728 ULE->getNameLoc(),
11729 Fn->getType(),
11730 VK_LValue,
11731 Found.getDecl(),
11732 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smithe6975e92012-04-17 00:58:00 +000011733 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011734 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1);
11735 return DRE;
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011736 }
11737
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011738 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000011739 // FIXME: avoid copy.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011740 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
11741 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
11742 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
11743 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
11744 }
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000011745
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011746 Expr *Base;
11747
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011748 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
11749 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011750 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
11751 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011752 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
11753 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000011754 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011755 Fn,
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +000011756 /*enclosing*/ false,
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011757 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
11758 Fn->getType(),
11759 VK_LValue,
11760 Found.getDecl(),
11761 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smithe6975e92012-04-17 00:58:00 +000011762 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011763 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1);
11764 return DRE;
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +000011765 } else {
11766 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
11767 if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000011768 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
Eli Friedman72899c32012-01-07 04:59:52 +000011769 CheckCXXThisCapture(Loc);
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +000011770 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
11771 MemExpr->getBaseType(),
11772 /*isImplicit=*/true);
11773 }
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011774 } else
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011775 Base = MemExpr->getBase();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011776
John McCallf5307512011-04-27 00:36:17 +000011777 ExprValueKind valueKind;
11778 QualType type;
11779 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
11780 valueKind = VK_LValue;
11781 type = Fn->getType();
11782 } else {
11783 valueKind = VK_RValue;
11784 type = Context.BoundMemberTy;
11785 }
11786
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011787 MemberExpr *ME = MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base,
11788 MemExpr->isArrow(),
11789 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000011790 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011791 Fn,
11792 Found,
11793 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
11794 TemplateArgs,
11795 type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary);
11796 ME->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
Richard Smith4a030222012-11-14 07:06:31 +000011797 MarkMemberReferenced(ME);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011798 return ME;
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011799 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011800
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011801 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011802}
11803
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011804ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011805 DeclAccessPair Found,
11806 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011807 return Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference((Expr *)E.get(), Found, Fn));
Douglas Gregor20093b42009-12-09 23:02:17 +000011808}
11809
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000011810} // end namespace clang